Philips 55POS9002/12 User Manual Uporabniški Priročnik 55pos9002 12 Dfu Eng
User Manual 55pos9002_12_dfu_eng
User Manual: Philips 55POS9002/12 Uporabniški priročnik Izjemno tanek OLED-televizor 4K s sistemom Android 55POS9002/12 | Philips55POS9002/12
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 173
Download | ![]() |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
Register your product and get support at POS9002 series www.philips.com/welcome User Manual 55POS9002 Contents 1 Setting Up 1.1 Read Safety 4 1.2 TV Stand and Wall Mounting 1.3 Tips on Placement 4 1.4 Power Cable 4 1.5 Antenna Cable 4 2 Remote Control 11 Sources 4 6 3 Switching On and Off 12 Networks 7 12.1 Network 12.2 Bluetooth 13 Settings 4 Channels 10 9 4.1 Install Channels 10 4.2 Channel Lists 10 4.3 Watching channels 11 4.4 Favourite Channels 13 4.5 Text / Teletext 14 5 Channel Installation 16 19 24 7 Connect your Android TV 8 Apps 15 TV Guide 9 Internet 10 TV Menu 60 16 Recording and Pause TV 16.1 Recording 16.2 Pause TV 62 62 63 17 Smartphones and Tablets 17.1 Philips TV Remote App 17.2 Google Cast 65 17.3 AirPlay 65 17.4 MHL 65 18 Top Picks 65 65 66 18.1 About Top Picks 66 18.2 Now on TV 66 18.3 TV on Demand 66 18.4 Video on Demand 67 32 32 19 Home Menu 68 19.1 Open the Home Menu 19.2 Restricted Profile 68 20 Netflix 36 21 Software 68 69 70 21.1 Update Software 70 21.2 Software Version 70 21.3 Automatic Software Update 21.4 Open Source Software 70 21.5 Open Source License 71 39 9.1 Start Internet 39 9.2 Options on Internet 56 15.1 What You Need 60 15.2 TV Guide Data 60 15.3 Using the TV Guide 60 35 8.1 About Apps 35 8.2 Google Play 35 8.3 App Gallery 36 8.4 Start or Stop an App 8.5 Lock Apps 36 8.6 Manage Apps 38 8.7 Storage 38 53 14.1 From a Computer or NAS 56 14.2 Favourites Menu 56 14.3 Most Popular Menu and Last Played Menu 14.4 From a USB Connection 56 14.5 Play your Videos 56 14.6 View your Photos 57 14.7 Play your Music 58 6.1 About Connections 24 6.2 CAM with Smart Card - CI+ 25 6.3 Home Theatre System - HTS 25 6.4 Smartphones and Tablets 26 6.5 Blu-ray Disc Player 26 6.6 DVD Player 26 6.7 Bluetooth 27 6.8 Headphones 27 6.9 Game Console 28 6.10 USB Hard Drive 28 6.11 USB Keyboard 29 6.12 USB Flash Drive 29 6.13 Photo Camera 30 6.14 Camcorder 30 6.15 Computer 30 7.1 Network and Internet 7.2 Google Account 33 44 14 Videos, Photos and Music 5.1 Satellite Installation 16 5.2 Antenna/Cable Installation 5.3 Channel List Copy 21 5.4 Satellite List Copy 22 6 Connect Devices 43 43 43 13.1 Picture 44 13.2 Sound 48 13.3 Ambilight Settings 49 13.4 Eco Settings 51 13.5 General Settings 51 13.6 Clock, Region, and Language Settings 13.7 Android Settings 54 13.8 Universal Access Settings 54 13.9 Lock Settings 54 9 9 41 11.1 Switch to a device 41 11.2 Options for a TV Input 41 11.3 Device Name and Type 41 11.4 Rescan Connections 41 2.1 Key overview 6 2.2 Pair Your Remote Control to TV 2.3 Voice search 7 2.4 IR Sensor 7 2.5 Batteries 8 2.6 Cleaning 8 3.1 On or standby 3.2 Keys on TV 40 40 10.1 About TV Menu 10.2 Open TV Menu 4 39 22 Specifications 40 2 159 70 56 22.1 Environmental 159 22.2 Power 159 22.3 Operating System 159 22.4 Reception 159 22.5 Display Type 160 22.6 Display Input Resolution 22.7 Connectivity 160 22.8 Sound 160 22.9 Multimedia 160 23 Help and Support 160 162 23.1 Register your TV 162 23.2 Using Help 162 23.3 Troubleshooting 162 23.4 Online Help 163 23.5 Support and Repair 164 24 Safety and Care 24.1 Safety 165 24.2 Screen Care 25 Terms of Use 165 166 167 25.1 Terms of Use - TV 167 25.2 Terms of Use - Smart TV 26 Copyrights 167 168 26.1 MHL 168 26.2 Ultra HD 168 26.3 HDMI 168 26.4 Dolby Audio 168 26.5 DTS Premium Sound ™ 168 26.6 Wi-Fi Alliance 168 26.7 Kensington 168 26.8 Other Trademarks 169 27 Disclaimer regarding services and/or software offered by third parties 170 Index 171 3 1 1.3 Setting Up Tips on Placement • Position the TV where light does not shine directly on the screen. • Dim lighting conditions in the room for best Ambilight effect. • Position the TV up to 15 cm away from the wall. • The ideal distance to watch TV is 3 times its diagonal screen size. When seated, your eyes should be level with the centre of the screen. 1.1 Read Safety Read the safety instructions first before you use the TV. To read the instructions, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Safety Instructions. 1.2 TV Stand and Wall Mounting TV Stand You can find the instructions for mounting the TV stand in the Quick Start Guide that came with the TV. In case you lost this guide, you can download it from www.philips.com. 1.4 Power Cable • Insert the power cable into the POWER connector on the back of the TV. • Make sure the power cable is securely inserted in the connector. • Make sure that the power plug, in the wall socket, is accessible at all times. • When you unplug the power cable, always pull the plug, never pull the cable. Use the product type number of the TV to look for the Quick Start Guide to download. Wall Mounting Your TV is also prepared for a VESA-compliant wall mount bracket (sold separately). Use the following VESA code when purchasing the wall mount . . . • 55POS9002 VESA MIS-F 300x300, M6 Preparation First remove the 4 plastic screw caps out of the threaded bushes on the back of the TV. Make sure that the metal screws, to mount the TV to the VESA-compliant bracket, go about 10mm deep inside the threaded bushes of the TV. Although this TV has a very low standby power consumption, unplug the power cable to save energy if you do not use the TV for a long period of time. Caution Wall mounting the TV requires special skills and should only be performed by qualified personnel. The TV wall mounting should meet safety standards according to the TVs weight. Also read the safety precautions before positioning the TV. TP Vision Europe B.V. bears no responsibility for improper mounting or any mounting that results in accident or injury. For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Switching On for more information on switching the TV on or off. 1.5 Antenna Cable Insert the antenna plug firmly into the Antenna socket at the back of the TV. You can connect your own antenna or an antenna signal from an antenna distribution system. Use an IEC Coax 75 Ohm RF antenna connector. 4 Use this antenna connection for DVB-T and DVB-C input signals. 5 2 Remote Control 2.1 Key overview Top 1 TV Menu To open the TV Menu with typical TV functions. 2 - SOURCES To open or close the Sources menu. 3 - INFO To open or close programme info. 1 - Standby / On To switch the TV on or back to Standby. 2- 4 - BACK • To switch back to the previous channel you selected. • To return to previous menu. VOICE microphone 3 - LIST To open or close the channel list. 5 - Colour keys Direct selection of options. 4 - AMBILIGHT To select one of the Ambilight style. 6 - EXIT To switch back to watching TV. 5 - TV GUIDE To open or close the TV Guide. 7 - OPTIONS To open or close the options menu. 6 - SETTINGS • To open the quick settings menu. • To pair the remote control to the TV. 8 - OK key To confirm a selection or setting. 9 - Arrow / navigation keys To navigate up, down, left or right. 7 - TOP PICKS To open the menu with recommended programmes, Video on Demand (Rental Videos) or Online TV (Catch Up TV). If available. 10 - HOME To open the Home menu. 8 - VOICE To start speaking your voice search. Bottom Middle 6 When you started the initial TV installation, the TV invited you to long press the PAIR key, and by doing so, the pairing was done. Note: If the TV does not launch the voice search field when press VOICE, pairing was unsuccessful. Pairing or pairing again If the pairing with the remote control was lost, you can pair the TV with the remote control again. You can simply long press the PAIR key (approximate for 3 seconds) for pairing. Alternatively, go (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and network > Remote control > Pair remote control, then follow the on-screen instructions. 1- To open the Netflix App directly. A message appears when the pairing is successful. 2 - Volume To adjust the volume level. Remote Control Software (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and network > Remote control > Current software info 3 - Number keys To select a channel directly. Once the remote control is paired, you can check the current remote control software version. 4 - SUBTITLE To switch Subtitles on, off or on during mute. (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and network > Remote control > Update remote control software 5 - Playback and Record • Play , to playback. • Pause , to pause playback • Stop , to stop playback • Rewind , to rewind • Fast forward , to go fast forward • Record , to start recording Check available remote control software for updates. 2.3 Voice search 6 - Channel To switch to the next or previous channel in the channel list. To open the next or previous page in Text/Teletext. You can search for videos, music or anything else on the Internet by simply using your voice. You can speak into the microphone on the remote control. 7 - Mute To mute the sound or to restore it. You need to pair the remote control to the TV before use voice search. 8 - TEXT To open or close Text/Teletext. To use Voice... 1 - Press and hold VOICE on remote control, the blue light on the remote control lights up and the search field opens, the microphone is active. 2 - Speak out what you are looking for with clear pronunciation. You can speak for 10 seconds before the microphone switches off. It might take some time for the results to appear. 3 - In the list of search results, you can select the item you want. Set the language you like to use with voice 2.2 Pair Your Remote Control to TV This remote control uses both Bluetooth and IR (infrared) to send its commands to the TV. interaction • You can use this remote control via IR (infrared) for most operations. • To use advanced operation like voice search and remote control keyboard, you need to pair (link) the TV with the remote control. (TV menu) > Settings > Android settings > Preferences > Speech 7 2.4 IR Sensor The TV can receive commands from a remote control that uses IR (infrared) to send commands. If you use such a remote control, always make sure you point the remote control at the infrared sensor on the front of the TV. Warning Do not put any objects in front of IR sensor of the TV, it may block the IR signal. 2.5 Batteries If the TV does not react on a key press on the remote control, the batteries might be empty. To replace the batteries, open the battery compartment on the front-bottom of the remote control. 1 - Use a small coin or other small, blunt object and press the rectangular shaped release button to open the battery lid. 2 - Replace the old batteries with 2 type AA-LR6-1.5V batteries. Make sure the + and the - ends of the batteries line up correctly. 3 - Reposition the battery door and slide it back until it clicks. • Remove the batteries if you are not using the remote control for a long time. • Safely dispose of your old batteries according to the end of use directions. 2.6 Cleaning Your remote control is treated with a scratch-resistant coating. To clean the remote control, use a soft damp cloth. Never use substances such as alcohol, chemicals or household cleaners on the remote control. 8 3 3.2 Switching On and Off Keys on TV If you lost the remote control or its batteries are empty, you can still do some basic TV operations. To open the basic menu… 3.1 1 - With the TV switched on, press the joystick key on the back of the TV to bring up the basic menu. 2 - Press left or right to select Volume, Channel or Sources. Select Demo, to start a demo movie. 3 - Press up or down to adjust the volume or tune to the next or previous channel. Press up or down to go through the list of sources, including the tuner selection. Press the joystick key to start the demo movie. 4 - The menu will disappear automatically. On or standby Make sure the TV is connected to the mains AC power. Connect the supplied power cord to the AC in connector at the back of the TV. The indicator light at the bottom of the TV lights up. Switch on Press on the remote control to switch the TV on. Alternatively, press HOME. You can also press the small joystick key on the back of the TV to switch the TV on in case you can't find the remote control or its batteries are empty. To switch the TV on standby, select and press the joystick key. Switch to standby To switch the TV to standby, press on the remote control. You can also press the small joystick key on the back of the TV. In standby mode, the TV is still connected to the mains power but consumes very little energy. To switch off the TV completely, disconnect the power plug. When disconnecting the power plug, always pull the power plug, never the cord. Ensure that you have full access to the power plug, power cord and outlet socket at all times. 9 1 - With a channel list open on screen, press OPTIONS. 2 - Select Select Channel List and press OK. 3 - In the list menu, select one of the available channel lists and press OK. 4 Channels 4.1 Alternatively, you can select the list name at the top of the channel list and press OK to open the list menu. Install Channels For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Channel, Antenna Installation or Channel, Cable Installation. Filter a Channel List 4.2 You can filter a list with all channels. You can set the channel list to show only TV channels or only Radio stations. For Antenna/Cable channels you can set the list to show the Free-to-Air or the Scrambled channels. Channel Lists About Channel Lists After a channel installation, all channels appear on the channel list. Channels are shown with their name and logo if this information is available. To set a filter on a list with all channels… 1 - Press . 2 - Press OK to open the current channel list. 3 - Press OPTIONS. 4 - Select Select Channel List and press OK. 5 - Select Filter Antenna Channels or Filter Cable Channels according to the list you want to filter, and press OK. 6 - In the Options menu, select the filter you want and press OK to activate. The name of the filter appears as part of the channel list name on top of the channel list. 7 - Press (left) to go back one step or press to close the menu. With a channel list selected, press the arrows (up) or (down) to select a channel, then press OK to watch the selected channel. You only tune to the channels in that list when using or keys. Channel icons After an Automatic Channel Update of the channel list, newly found channels are marked with a (star). If you lock a channel, it will be marked with a (lock). Radio stations Search for a Channel If digital broadcasting is available, digital radio stations are installed during installation. Switch to a radio channel just like you switch to a TV channel. A Cable (DVB-C) channel installation usually places radio stations from channel number 1001 onwards. You can search for a channel to find it in a long list of channels. The TV can search for a channel within one of the 2 main channel lists - the Antenna or Cable channel list. This TV can receive digital television standard DVB . TV may not work properly with some operators of digital television , non-compliance with requirements of the standard in full. To search for a channel… 1 - Press . 2 - Press OK to open the current channel list. 3 - Press OPTIONS. 4 - Select Select Channel List and press OK. 5 - Select Filter Antenna Channels or Filter Cable Channels and press OK. 6 - Select Search Channel and press OK to open a text field.You can use the remote control keyboard (if available) or the on-screen keyboard to enter text. 7 - Enter a number, a name or part of a name and select Apply and press OK. The TV will search for matching channel names in the list you selected. Open a Channel List Next to the list with all channels, you can select a filtered list or you can select one of the favourite lists you created. To open the current channel list… 1 - Press , to switch to TV. 2 - Press OK to open the current channel list. 3 - Press BACK to close the channel list. Search results are listed as a channel list - see the list name at the top. The search results disappear once you select another channel list or close the list with To select one of the channel lists… 10 search results. If you lock or unlock channels in a channel list, you only have to enter the PIN code just once until you close the channel list. 4.3 For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Child Lock for more information. Watching channels Tune to a Channel Parental Rating To start watching TV channels, press . The TV tunes to the channel you last watched. To prevent children from watching a programme not suitable for their age, you can set an age rating. Switch Channels Digital channels can have their programmes age rated. When the age rating of a programme is equal to or higher than the age you have set as age rating for your child, the programme will be locked. To watch a locked programme, you must enter the Parental Rating code first. To switch channels, press or . If you know the channel number, type in the number with the number keys. Press OK after you entered the number to switch immediately. If the information is available from the Internet, the TV shows the current programme name and details followed by the next programme name and details. To set an age rating… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Child Lock > Parental Rating and press OK. 3 - Enter a 4-digit Child lock code. If you did not set a code yet, select Set Code in Child Lock. Enter a 4-digit Child lock code and confirm. Now you can set an age rating. 4 - Back in Parental Rating, select the age and press OK. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Previous channel To switch back to the previously tuned channel, press BACK. You can also tune to channels from a Channel List. Lock a Channel Lock and Unlock a Channel To switch off the parental age rating, select None. However, in some countries you must set an age rating. To prevent children from watching a channel, you can lock a channel. To watch a locked channel, you must enter the 4 digit Child Lock PIN code first. You cannot lock programmes from connected devices. For some broadcasters/operators, the TV only locks programmes with a higher rating. The parental age rating is set for all channels. To lock a channel… 1 - Press . 2 - Press OK to open the channel list. If necessary change the channel list. 3 - Select the channel you want to lock. 4 - Press OPTIONS and select Lock Channel and press OK. 5 - Enter your 4 digit PIN code if the TV asks for it. A locked channel is marked with a (lock). 6 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. Channel Options Open Options While watching a channel, you can set some options. Depending on the type of channel you are watching (analogue or digital) or depending on the TV settings you made, some options are available. To unlock a channel… To open the options menu… 1 - Press . 2 - Press OK to open the channel list. If necessary change the channel list. 3 - Select the channel you want to unlock. 4 - Press OPTIONS and select Unlock Channel and press OK. 5 - Enter your 4 digit PIN code if the TV asks for it. 6 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. 1 - While watching a channel, press OPTIONS. 2 - Press OPTIONS again to close. 11 Subtitles Select a Subtitle Language Switch On If none of the preferred subtitle languages are available, you can select another subtitle language if available. If no subtitle languages are available, you cannot select this option. Digital broadcasts can have subtitles for their programmes. To show the subtitles… To select a subtitle language when none of your preferred languages are available… Press SUBTITLE. You can switch subtitles On or you can select Automatic. 1 - Press OPTIONS. 2 - Select Subtitle Language and select one of the languages as subtitles temporarily. Off. Alternatively Automatic If language information is part of the digital broadcast and the broadcasted programme is not in your language (the language set on TV), the TV can show subtitles automatically in one of your preferred subtitle languages. One of these subtitle languages must also be part of the broadcast. Audio Language Preferred Audio Language A digital broadcast can offer several audio languages (spoken languages) for a programme. You can set a preferred primary and secondary audio language. If audio in one of these languages is available, the TV will switch to the audio language. You can select your preferred subtitle languages in Subtitle Language. To set the primary and secondary audio language… Subtitles from Text 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Region and Language and select Languages > Primary Audio or Secondary Audio. 3 - Select the language you need and press OK. 4 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. If you tune to an analogue channel, you need to make the subtitles available for each channel manually. 1 - Switch to a channel and press TEXT to open Text. 2 - Enter the page number for subtitles, usually 888. 3 - Press TEXT again, to close Text. If you select On in the Subtitle menu when watching this analogue channel, subtitles will be shown if available. Select an Audio Language If none of the preferred audio languages are available, you can select another audio language if available. If no audio languages are available, you cannot select this option. To know if a channel is analogue or digital, switch to the channel and open Information in OPTIONS. To select an audio language when none of your preferred languages are available… Subtitle Language 1 - Press OPTIONS. 2 - Select Audio Language and select one of the languages as audio temporarily. Preferred Subtitle Languages A digital broadcast can offer several subtitle languages for a programme. You can set a preferred primary and secondary subtitle language. If subtitles in one of these languages are available, the TV will show the subtitles you selected. Common Interface If you installed a CAM in one of the Common Interface slots, you can view the CAM and operator information or do some CAM related settings. To set the primary and secondary subtitle language… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Region and Language > Languages > Primary Subtitles or Secondary Subtitles. 3 - Select the language you need and press OK. 4 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. To view the CAM information… 1 - Press SOURCES. 2 - Select the channel type you are using the CAM for Watch TV. 3 - Press OPTIONS and select Common Interface. 12 4 - Select the appropriate Common Interface slot and press (right). 5 - Select the TV operator of the CAM and press OK. The following screens come from the TV operator. until you close the Favourites List with the BACK key. 4.4 Favourite Channels HbbTV on this Channel About Favourite Channels If you want to avoid access to HbbTV pages on a specific channel, you can block the HbbTV pages for this channel only. In a favourite channel list, you can collect the channels you like. Switch on HbbTV You can create 4 different lists of favourite channels for easy channel zapping. You can name each Favourites List individually. Only in a Favourites List you can reorder channels. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > HbbTV settings > HbbTV > On. With a Favourites List selected, press the arrows (up) or (down) to select a channel, then press OK to watch the selected channel. You only tune to the channels in that list when using or keys. Information You can view the technical characteristics of a particular channel, like digital or analogue, sound type, etc. To view the technical information on a channel… Create a Favourites List 1 - Tune to the channel. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Information and press OK. 3 - To close this screen, press OK. To create a favourite channels list… 1 - Press , to switch to TV. 2 - Press OK to open the current channel list. 3 - Press OPTIONS. 4 - Select Create Favourites List and press OK. 5 - In the list at the left, select a channel you want as a favourite and press OK. Channels come in the list at the right in the order you add them. To undo, select the channel in the list at the left and press OK again. 6 - If necessary, you can go on selecting and adding channels as favourites. 7 - To finish adding channels, press BACK. Mono / Stereo You can switch the sound of an analogue channel to Mono or Stereo. To switch to Mono or Stereo… 1 - Tune to an analoge channel. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Mono/Stereo and press (right). 3 - Select Mono or Stereo and press OK. 4 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. The TV will ask to rename the Favourites List. You can use the on-screen keyboard. 1 - Use the on-screen keyboard to delete the current name and enter a new name. 2 - When done, select Close and press OK. Reorder Channels The TV will switch to the newly created Favourites List. Only in a Favourites List you can change the sequence of channels (reorder). You can add a range of channels in one go or start a Favourites List by duplicating the channel list with all channels and removing the channels you do not want. To change the sequence of channels… 1 - Open the Favourites List you want to reorder. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Reorder Channels and press OK. 3 - In the Favourites List, select the channel you want to reorder and press OK. 4 - With the (up) or (down) keys move the channel where you want it. 5 - Press OK to confirm the new location. 6 - You can reorder channels with the same method The channels in the Favourites List are renumbered. 13 4 - With the (up) or (down) keys move the channel where you want it. 5 - Press OK to confirm the new location. 6 - You can reorder channels with the same method until you close the Favourites List with the BACK key. Add a Range of Channels To add a consecutive range of channels to a Favourites List in one go, you can use Select Range. To add a range of channels… 1 - Open the Favourites List where you want to add a range of channels. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Select Range and press OK. 3 - In the list at the left select the first channel of the range you want to add and press OK. 4 - Press (down) to select the last channel of the range you want to add. The channels are marked at the left. 5 - Press OK to add this range of channels and confirm. 4.5 Text / Teletext Text Pages To open Text/Teletext press TEXT, while you are watching TV channels. To close Text, press TEXT again. Select a Text page You can also start creating a Favourites List from Select Range. To select a page . . . 1 - Enter the page number with the number keys. 2 - Use the arrow keys to navigate. 3 - Press a colour key to select a colour-coded subject at the bottom of the screen. Rename a Favourites List You can only rename a Favourites List. Text sub-pages To rename a Favourites List… A Text page number can hold several subpages. The subpage numbers are shown on a bar next to the main page number. To select a subpage, press or . 1 - Open the Favourite List you want to rename. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Rename Favourites List and press OK. 3 - Use the on-screen keyboard to delete the current name and enter a new name. 4 - When done, select Close and press OK. 5 - Press BACK to close the channel list. T.O.P. Text pages Some broadcasters offer T.O.P. Text. To open T.O.P. Text pages within Text, press OPTIONS and select T.O.P. Overview. Favourite pages Remove a Favourites List The TV makes a list of the last 10 Text pages you opened. You can easily reopen them again in the Favourite Text pages column. You can only remove a Favourites List. To remove a Favourites List… 1 - In Text, select (heart) in the top left corner of the screen to show the column of favourite pages. 2 - Press (down) or (up) to select a page number and press OK to open the page. You can clear the list with the option Clear Favourite Pages. 1 - Open the Favourites List you want to remove. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Remove Favourites List and press OK. 3 - Confirm to remove the list. 4 - Press BACK to close the channel list. Search Text Reorder Channels You can select a word and scan Text for all occurences of this word. Only in a Favourites List you can change the sequence of channels (reorder). 1 - Open a Text page and press OK. 2 - Select a word or number with the arrow keys. 3 - Press OK again to jump immediately to the next occurence of this word or number. 4 - Press OK again to jump to the subsequent occurence. 5 - To stop searching, press (up) until nothing is selected. To change the sequence of channels… 1 - Open the Favourites List you want to reorder. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Reorder Channels and press OK. 3 - In the Favourites List, select the channel you want to reorder and press OK. Text from a connected device 14 Some devices that receive TV channels can also offer Text. To open Text from a connected device . . . 3 - Select Language > Primary Text or Secondary Text and press OK. 4 - Select your preferred Text languages. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 1 - Press SOURCES, select the device and press OK. 2 - While watching a channel on the device, press OPTIONS, select Show Device Keys and select the key and press OK. 3 - Press BACK to hide the device keys. 4 - To close Text, press BACK again. Text 2.5 If available, Text 2.5 offers more colours and better graphics. Text 2.5 is activated as a standard factory setting. To switch off Text 2.5… Digital Text (UK only) 1 - Press TEXT. 2 - With Text/Teletext open on screen, press OPTIONS. 3 - Select Text 2.5 > Off and press OK. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Some digital broadcasters offer dedicated Digital Text or interactive TV on their digital TV channels. This includes normal Text using the number, colour and arrow keys to select and navigate. To close Digital Text, press BACK. Text Options In Text/Teletext, press OPTIONS to select the following… • Freeze page To stop the automatic rotation of subpages. • Dual screen / Full screen To show the TV channel and Text alongside each other. • T.O.P. overview To open T.O.P. Text. • Enlarge To enlarge the Text page for comfortable reading. • Reveal To unhide hidden information on a page. • Cycle subpages To cycle subpages when these are available. • Hide/Show Favourite Pages To hide or show the list of favourite pages. • Clear Favourite Pages To clear the list of favourite pages. • Language To switch the group of characters that Text uses to display correctly. • Text 2.5 To activate the Text 2.5 for more colours and better graphics. Text Setup Text language Some digital TV broadcasters have several Text languages available. To set your primary and secondary Text language . . . 1 - Press , select All Settings and press 2 - Select Region and Language and press (right) to enter the menu. OK. 15 select Install. 9 - If a satellite offers Channel Packages, the TV will show the available packages for that satellite. Select the package you need. Some packages offer a Quick or Full install for their available channels, select one or the other. The TV will install the satellite channels and radio stations. 10 - To store the satellite setup and installed channels and radio stations, select Finish. 5 Channel Installation 5.1 Satellite Installation About Installing Satellites Up to 4 Satellites Satellite Installation Settings You can install up to 4 satellites (4 LNBs) on this TV. Select the exact number of satellites you wish to install at the start of the installation. This will speed up the installation. The satellite installation settings are preset according your country. These settings determine how the TV searches and installs satellites and its channels. You can always change these settings. Unicable To change the satellite installation settings… You can use a Unicable system to connect the antenna dish to the TV. You can select Unicable for 1 or for 2 satellites at the start of the installation. 1 - Start the satellite installation. 2 - On the screen where you can start searching for satellites, select Settings and press OK. 3 - Select the number of satellites you want to install or select one of the Unicable systems. When you select Unicable, you can choose the User Band Numbers and enter the User Band Frequencies for each tuner. 4 - When you're done, select Next and press OK. 5 - On the Settings menu, press the colour key Done to return to the screen to start searching for satellites. MDU - Multi-Dwelling-Unit The built-in satellite tuners support MDU on the Astra satellites and for Digiturk on the Eutelsat satellite. MDU on Türksat is not supported. Start the Installation Make sure your satellite dish is connected correctly and is perfectly aligned before you start the installation. Homing Transponder and LNB In some countries, you can adjust the expert settings for homing transponder and each LNB. Only use or change these settings when a normal installation fails. If you have non-standard satellite equipment, you can use these settings to overrule the standard settings. Some providers might give you some transponder or LNB valeus which you can enter here. To start the satellite installation… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Satellite Installation and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 3 - Select Search for Satellite and press OK. 4 - Select Search and press OK. TV will search for satellites. 5 - Select Install and press OK. The TV shows the current satellite installation setup. If you want to change this setup, select Settings. If you don't want to change the setup, select Search. Go to step 5. Satellite CAMs If you use a CAM – a Conditional Access Module with a smart card – to watch satellite channels, we recommend to do the satellite installation with the CAM inserted in the TV. 6 - In Installation System, select the number of satellites you want to install or select one of the Unicable systems. When you select Unicable, you can choose the User Band Numbers and enter the User Band Frequencies for each tuner. In some countries, you can adjust some expert settings for each LNB in More Settings. 7 - The TV will search for the satellites available on the alignment of your antenna dish. This may take a few minutes. If a satellite is found, its name and reception strength are shown on screen. 8 - When the TV found the satellites you need, Most CAMs are used to descramble channels. Newest generation CAMs (CI+ 1.3 with Operator Profile), can install all the satellite channels by themselves on your TV. The CAM will invite you to install its satellite(s) and channels. These CAMs not only install and descramble the channels but also handle regular channel updates. 16 Channel Packages User Band Frequency Satellite operators can offer channel packages that bundle free channels (free-to-air) and offer a sorting that suits a country. Some satellites offer subscription packages - a collection of channels you pay for. Next to the unique user band number, the built-in satellite receiver needs the frequency of the selected user band number. These frequencies are mostly shown next to the user band number on a Unicable switchbox. If you choose a subscription package, the TV might ask you to select a Quick or Full installation. Select Quick to install the channels of the package only or select Full to install the package and all other available channels too. We recommend a Quick installation for subscription packages. If you have additional satellites that are not part of your subscription package, we recommend a Full installation. All installed channels are put in the channels list All. Manual Channel Update You can always start an channel update yourself. To start a channel update manually… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Satellite Installation and press OK. 3 - Select Search for Channels and press OK. 4 - Select Update Channels and press OK. The TV will start updating. The update may take a few minutes. 5 - Follow the instructions on screen. The update may take a few minutes. 6 - Select Finish and press OK. Unicable Setup The Unicable System You can use a Single Cable system, MDU or Unicable system to connect the antenna dish to the TV. A Single Cable system uses one cable to connect the satellite dish to all satellite tuners in its system. A Single Cable system is typically used in apartment buildings. If you use a Unicable system, the TV will ask you to assign a user band number and corresponding frequency during the installation. You can install 1 or 2 satellites with Unicable on this TV. Add a Satellite You can add an additional satellite to your current satellite installation. The installed satellites and their channels remain untouched. Some satellite operators do not allow adding a satellite. If you notice some missing channels after a Unicable installation, another installation might have been done at the same moment on the Unicable system. Do the installation again to install the missing channels. The additional satellite should be seen as an extra, it is not your main satellite subscription or not the main satellite of which you use its channel package. Typically, you would add a 4th satellite when you have 3 satellites already installed. If you have 4 satellites installed, you might consider removing one first to be able to add a new satellite. User Band Number Setup In a Unicable system, each connected satellite tuner must be numbered (e.g. 0, 1, 2 or 3 etc.). If you currently have only 1 or 2 satellites installed, the current installation settings might not allow adding an extra satellite. If you need to change the installation settings, you must redo the complete satellite installation. You cannot use Add satellite if a change of settings is needed. You can find the available user bands and their number on the Unicable switchbox. User band is sometimes shortened as UB. There are Unicable switchboxes that offer 4 or 8 user bands. If you select Unicable in the settings, the TV will ask you to assign the unique user band number for each built-in satellite tuners. A satellite tuner cannot have the same user band number as another satellite tuner in the Unicable system. To add a satellite… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Satellite Installation and press OK. 3 - Select Search for satellite and press OK. 4 - Select Add Satellite and press OK. The current satellites are shown. 5 - Select Search and press OK. The TV will search for new satellites. 6 - If the TV has found one or more satellites, select Install and press OK. The TV installs the 17 channels of the found satellites. 7 - Select Finish and press OK to store the channels and radio stations. Homing Transponder and LNB In some countries, you can adjust the expert settings for homing transponder and each LNB. Only use or change these settings when a normal installation fails. If you have non-standard satellite equipment, you can use these settings to overrule the standard settings. Some providers might give you some transponder or LNB valeus which you can enter here. Remove a Satellite You can remove one or more satellites from your current satellite installation. You remove the satellite and its channels. Some satellite operators do not allow removing a satellite. LNB Power To remove satellites… By default, LNB Power is set to On. 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Satellite Installation and press OK. 3 - Select Search for satellite and press OK. 4 - Select Remove Satellite and press OK. The current satellites are shown. 5 - Select a satellite and press OK to mark or unmark them to remove. 6 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 22 kHz Tone By default, the Tone is set to Auto. Low LO Frequency / High LO Frequency The local oscillator frequencies are set to standard values. Adjust the values only in case of exceptional equipment that needs different values. Problems Manual Installation The TV cannot find the satellites I want or the TV Manual Installation is intended for expert users. • Make sure that the correct number of satellites is set in Settings at the start of the installation. You can set the TV to search for One, Two or 3/4 satellites. installs the same satellite twice You can use Manual Installation to quickly add new channels from a satellite transponder. You need to know the frequency and polarization of the transponder. The TV will install all channels of that transponder. If the transponder was installed before, all its channels - the former and the new ones - are moved to the end of the channel list All. You cannot use Manual installation if you need to change the number of satellites. If this is needed, you have to do a complete installation with Install Satellites. A dual head LNB cannot find a second satellite • If the TV finds one satellite but cannot find a second one, turn the dish a few degrees. Align the dish to get the strongest signal on the first satellite. Check the signal strength indicator of the first satellite on screen. With the first satellite set at the strongest signal, select Search again to find the second satellite. • Make sure the settings are set to Two Satellites. To install a transponder… Changing the installation settings did not solve my 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Satellite Installation and press OK. 3 - Select Manual Installation and press (right) to enter the menu. 4 - If you have more than 1 satellite installed, select LNB for which you want to add channels. 5 - Set the Polarisation you need. If you set the Symbol Rate Mode to Manual, you can enter the symbol rate in Symbol Rate manually. 6 - Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the frequency, and select Done. 7 - Select Search and press OK. The signal strenght is shown on screen. 8 - If you want to store the channels of a new transponder, select Store and press OK. 9 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. problem • All settings, satellites and channels are only stored at the end of the installation when you finish. All satellite channels are gone • If you use a Unicable system, make sure you assigned two unique user band numbers for both built-in tuners in the Unicable settings. It might be that another satellite receiver in your Unicable system is using the same user band number. Some satellite channels seem to have disappeared from the channel list • If some channels seem to be gone or displaced, the broadcaster might have changed the transponder location of these channels. To restore the channel positions in the channel list, you can try an update of 18 the channel package. Manual Channel Update I cannot remove a satellite You can always start an channel update yourself. • Subscription packages do not allow removing a satellite. To remove the satellite, you have to do a complete installation again and select another package. To start a channel update manually… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. 3 - Enter your PIN code if necessary. 4 - Select Search for Channels and press OK. 5 - Select Start and press OK. 6 - Select Update Digital Channels, select Next and press OK. 7 - Select Start and press OK to update the digital channels. This can take a few minutes. 8 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. Sometimes the reception is poor • Check if the satellite dish is solidly mounted. Strong winds can move the dish. • Snow and rain can degrade the reception. 5.2 Antenna/Cable Installation Update Channels Reinstall Channels Automatic Channel Update Reinstall All Channels If you receive digital channels, you can set the TV to automatically update these channels. You can reinstall all channels and leave all other TV settings untouched. Once a day, at 6 AM, the TV updates the channels and stores new channels. New channels are stored in the Channels List and are marked with a . Channels without a signal are removed. The TV must be in standby to automatically update channels. You can switch off Auromatic Channel Update. If a PIN code is set, you will need to enter this code before you can reinstall channels. To reinstall channels… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. 3 - Enter your PIN code if necessary. 4 - Select Search for Channels and press OK. 5 - Select Start and press OK. 6 - Select Reinstall Channels, select Next and press OK. 7 - Select the country where you are now and press OK. 8 - Select Next and press OK. 9 - Select the type of installation you want, Antenna (DVB-T) or Cable (DVB-C) and press OK. 8 - Select Next and press OK. 11 - Select the type of channels you want, Digital and Analogue Channels or Only Digital Channels and press OK. 8 - Select Next and press OK. 13 - Select Start and press OK to update the digital channels. This can take a few minutes. 14 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. To switch off the automatic update… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. 3 - Enter your PIN code if necessary. 4 - Select Automatic Channel Update and press OK. 5 - Select Off and press OK. 6 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. When new channels are found or if channels are updated or removed, a message is shown at TV start up. To avoid this message to appear after every channel update, you can switch it off. To switch off the message… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. 3 - Enter your PIN code if necessary. 4 - Select Channel Update Message and press OK. 5 - Select Off and press OK. 6 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. Reinstall TV You can redo a full TV installation. The TV is completely reinstalled. In certain countries, the Automatic channel update is done while watching TV or on any moment when the TV is in standby. To redo a full TV installation… 19 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select General Settings > Reinstall TV and press OK. 3 - Enter your PIN code if necessary. 4 - Select Yes and press OK to confirm. 5 - The TV will reinstall completely. All settings will be reset and installed channels will be replaced. The installation can take a few minutes. 6 - Press (left) to go back one step or press BACK to close the menu. Frequency Scan Select the method of searching for channels. You can select the faster Quick Scan method and use the predefined settings used by most cable operator in your country. If this results in having no channels installed or if some channels are missing, you can select the extended Full Scan method. This method will take more time to search for and install channels. DVB-T or DVB-C Frequency Step Size DVB-T or DVB-C Reception The TV searches for channels in steps of 8MHz. During the channel installation, just before you search for channels, you selected Antenna (DVB-T) or Cable (DVB-C). Antenna DVB-T searches for terrestrial analogue channels and digital DVB-T/T2 channels. Cable DVB-C searches for analogue and digital channels available from a cable DVB-C operator. If this results in having no channels installed or if some channels are missing, you can search in smaller steps of 1MHz. Using the 1MHz steps will take more time to search for and install channels. Digital Channels DVB-C Channel Installation If you know your cable operator is not offering digital channels, you can skip searching for digital channels. For ease of use, all DVB-C settings are set to automatic. If your DVB-C operator gave you specific DVB-C values, the network ID or network frequency, enter these values when the TV asks for them during installation. Analogue Channels If you know your cable operator is not offering analogue channels, you can skip searching for analogue channels. Channel Number Conflicts In some countries, different TV channels (broadcasters) might have the same channel number. While installing, the TV shows the list with channel number conflicts. You need to select which TV channel you want to install on a channel number with multiple TV channels. Free / Scrambled If you have a subscription and a CAM - Conditional Access Module for pay TV services, select Free + Scrambled. If you did not subscribe to pay TV channels or services, you can select Free Channels Only . DVB Settings For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up CAM, Conditional Access Module. Network Frequency Mode If you intend to use the fast Quick Scan method in Frequency Scan to search for channels, select Automatic. The TV will use 1 of the predefined network frequencies (or HC - homing channel) as used by most cable operator in your country. Reception Quality You can check the quality and signal strength of a digital channel. If you have your own antenna, you can reposition the antenna to try and improve the reception. If you received a specific network frequency value to search for channels, select Manual. Network Frequency To check the reception quality of a digital channel… With the Network Frequency Mode set to Manual, you can enter the network frequency value received from your cable operator here. To enter the value, use the number keys. 1 - Tune to the channel. 2 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 3 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 20 4 - Select Digital: Reception Test and press OK. 5 - Select Search and press OK. The digital frequency is shown for this channel. 6 - Select Search again and press OK to check the signal quality of this frequency. The test result is shown on screen. You can reposition the antenna or check the connections to possibly improve the reception. 7 - You can also change the frequency yourself. Select the frequency number one by one and use the (up) or (down) keys to change the value. Select Search and press OK to test the reception again. 8 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 5.3 Channel List Copy Introduction Channel List Copy is intended for dealers and expert users. With Channel List Copy, you can copy the channels installed on one TV onto another Philips TV of the same range. With Channel List Copy, you avoid the time-consuming channel search by uploading a predefined channel list on a TV. Use a USB flash drive of minimum 1 GB. Conditions • Both TVs are from the same year range. • Both TVs have the same hardware type. Check the hardware type on the TV type plate on the back of the TV. Typically noted as Q . . . LA • Both TVs have compatible software versions. Manual Installation Analogue TV channels can be manually installed, channel by channel. Current channel version To install analogue channels manually… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels > Antenna/Cable Installation and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 3 - Select Analogue: Manual Installation and press OK. To check the current version of the channel list… • System To set up the TV system, select System. Select your country or the part of the world where you are now and press OK. To check the cuurent version of the TV software… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels, select Channel List Copy, select Current Version and press OK. 3 - Press OK to close. Current software version 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Current Software Info and press OK. 4 - The version, release notes and creation date are shown. Also, the Netflix ESN Number is shown if available. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. • Search Channel To find a channel, select Search Channel and press OK. You can enter a frequency yourself to find a channel or let the TV search for a channel. Press (right) to select Search and press OK to search for a channel automatically. The found channel is shown on screen and if the reception is poor, press Search again. If you want to store the channel, select Done and press OK. Copy a Channel List • Store You can store the channel on the current channel number or as a new channel number. Select Store Current Channel or Store as New Channel and press OK. The new channel number is shown briefly. To copy a channel list… 1 - Switch on the TV. This TV should have channels installed. 2 - Plug in a USB flash drive. 3 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Channel List Copy and press OK. 5 - Select Copy to USB and press OK. You might be asked to enter the Child Lock PIN code to copy the channel list. 6 - When copying is done, unplug the USB flash drive. 7 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. You can redo these steps until you have found all available analogue TV channels. 21 Now you can upload the copied channel list onto another Philips TV. select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Channel List Copy > Copy to TV and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 5 - The TV notifies you if the channel list is copied to the TV successfully. Unplug the USB flash drive. Channel List Version Check the current version of the channel list... 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Channel List Copy and select Current Version, then press OK. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 5.4 Satellite List Copy Introduction Satellite List Copy is intended for dealers and expert users. With Satellite List Copy, you can copy the channels installed on one TV onto another Philips TV of the same range. With Satellite List Copy, you avoid the time-consuming channel search by uploading a predefined channel list on a TV. Use a USB flash drive of minimum 1 GB. Upload a Channel List To not Installed TVs Depending on whether your TV is already installed or not, you must use a different method to upload a channel list. Conditions • Both TVs are from the same year range. • Both TVs have the same hardware type. Check the hardware type on the TV type plate on the back of the TV. Typically noted as Q . . . LA • Both TVs have compatible software versions. To a TV that is not yet installed 1 - Plug in the power plug to start the installation and select language and country. You can skip the channel search. Finish the installation. 2 - Plug in the USB flash drive that holds the channel list of the other TV. 3 - To start the channel list upload, press , select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Channel List Copy > Copy to TV and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 5 - The TV notifies you if the channel list is copied to the TV successfully. Unplug the USB flash drive. Current channel version To check the current version of the channel list… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels, select Satellite List Copy, select Current Version and press OK. 3 - Press OK to close. Current software version To check the cuurent version of the TV software… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Current Software Info and press OK. 4 - The version, release notes and creation date are shown. Also, the Netflix ESN Number is shown if available. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. To Installed TVs Depending on whether your TV is already installed or not, you must use a different method to upload a channel list. To an already installed TV 1 - Verify the country setting of the TV. (To verify this setting, see chapter Reinstall All Channels. Start this procedure until you reach the country setting. Press BACK to cancel the installation.) If the country is correct continue with step 2. If the country is not correct, you need to start a reinstallation. See chapter Reinstall All Channels and start the installation. Select the correct country and skip the channels search. Finish the installation. When done, continue with step 2. 2 - Plug in the USB flash drive that holds the channel list of the other TV. 3 - To start the channel list upload, press , Copy a Channel List To copy a channel list… 1 - Switch on the TV. This TV should have channels installed. 2 - Plug in a USB flash drive. 3 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Satellite List Copy and press OK. 22 5 - Select Copy to USB and press OK. You might be asked to enter the Child Lock PIN code to copy the channel list. 6 - When copying is done, unplug the USB flash drive. 7 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. reinstallation. See chapter Reinstall All Channels and start the installation. Select the correct country and skip the channels search. Finish the installation. When done, continue with step 2. 2 - Plug in the USB flash drive that holds the channel list of the other TV. 3 - To start the channel list upload, press , select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Satellite List Copy > Copy to TV and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 5 - The TV notifies you if the channel list is copied to the TV successfully. Unplug the USB flash drive. Now you can upload the copied channel list onto another Philips TV. Channel List Version Check the current version of the channel list... 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Channels and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Satellite List Copy and select Current Version, then press OK. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Upload a Channel List To not Installed TVs Depending on whether your TV is already installed or not, you must use a different method to upload a channel list. To a TV that is not yet installed 1 - Plug in the power plug to start the installation and select language and country. You can skip the channel search. Finish the installation. 2 - Plug in the USB flash drive that holds the channel list of the other TV. 3 - To start the channel list upload, press , select All Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Channels > Satellite List Copy > Copy to TV and press OK. Enter your PIN code if necessary. 5 - The TV notifies you if the channel list is copied to the TV successfully. Unplug the USB flash drive. To Installed TVs Depending on whether your TV is already installed or not, you must use a different method to upload a channel list. To an already installed TV 1 - Verify the country setting of the TV. (To verify this setting, see chapter Reinstall All Channels. Start this procedure until you reach the country setting. Press BACK to cancel the installation.) If the country is correct continue with step 2. If the country is not correct, you need to start a 23 6 HDMI ARC Connect Devices All of the HDMI connections on the TV have HDMI ARC (Audio Return Channel). 6.1 If the device, typically a Home Theatre System (HTS), also has the HDMI ARC connection, connect it to any of the HDMI connections on this TV. With the HDMI ARC connection, you do not need to connect the extra audio cable that sends the sound of the TV picture to the HTS. The HDMI ARC connection combines both signals. About Connections Connectivity Guide Always connect a device to the TV with the highest quality connection available. Also, use good quality cables to ensure a good transfer of picture and sound. You can use any HDMI connection on this TV to connect the HTS but ARC is only available for 1 device/connection at a time. When you connect a device, the TV recognizes its type and gives each device a correct type name. You can change the type name if you wish. If a correct type name for a device is set, the TV automatically switches to the ideal TV settings when you switch to this device in the Sources menu. Antenna port If you have a Set-top box (a digital receiver) or Recorder, connect the antenna cables to run the antenna signal through the Set-top box and/or Recorder first before it enters the TV. In this way, the antenna and the Set-top box can send possible additional channels to the Recorder to record. HDMI MHL With HDMI MHL, you can send what you see on your Android smartphone or tablet to a TV screen. HDMI ports The HDMI 1 connection on this TV incorporates MHL 2.0 (Mobile High-Definition Link). HDMI Quality This wired connection offers great stability and bandwidth, low latency, no wireless interference and good quality sound reproduction. On top of that, the MHL connection will charge the battery of your smartphone or tablet. Although connected, your mobile device will not be charging when the TV is on standby. An HDMI connection has the best picture and sound quality. One HDMI cable combines video and audio signals. Use an HDMI cable for TV signal. For best signal quality transfer, use a High speed HDMI cable and do not use an HDMI cable longer than 5 m. Inform yourself about what passive MHL cable is suited for your mobile device. In particular, with the HDMI connector for the TV on one side, the type of connector you need to connect to your smartphone or tablet. If a device connected with HDMI is not working correctly, check if a different HDMI Ultra HD setting can solve this problem. In Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up HDMI Ultra HD. Copy protection MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link and the MHL Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of the MHL, LLC. HDMI cables support HDCP 2.2 (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection). HDCP is a copy protection signal that prevents copying content from a DVD disc or Blu-ray Disc. Also referred to as DRM (Digital Rights Management). 24 HDMI CEC - EasyLink An HDMI connection has the best picture and sound quality. One HDMI cable combines video and audio signals. Use an HDMI cable for High Definition (HD) TV signals. For best signal quality transfer, use a High speed HDMI cable and do not use an HDMI cable longer than 5 m. Smart Card Connect HDMI CEC-compatible devices to your TV, you can operate them with the TV remote control. Switch on EasyLink Digital TV operators provide a CI+ module (Conditional Access Module - CAM) and an accompanying smart card, when you subscribe to their premium programmes. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > EasyLink > EasyLink > On. Insert the smart card into the CAM module. See the instruction you received from the operator. EasyLink HDMI CEC must be switched on on the TV and the connected device. To insert the CAM in the TV… 1 - Look on the CAM for the correct method of insertion. Incorrect insertion can damage the CAM and TV. 2 - While looking at the back of the TV, with the front of the CAM facing towards you, gently insert the CAM into the slot COMMON INTERFACE. 3 - Push the CAM in as far as it will go. Leave it in the slot permanently. Operate HDMI CEC-compatible devices with TV remote control (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > EasyLink > EasyLink remote control > On. Note: • EasyLink might not work with devices from other brands. • The HDMI CEC functionality has different names on different brands. Some examples are: Anynet, Aquos Link, Bravia Theatre Sync, Kuro Link, Simplink and Viera Link. Not all brands are fully compatible with EasyLink. Example HDMI CEC branding names are property of their respective owners. 6.2 CAM with Smart Card - CI+ CI+ When you switch on the TV, it may take a few minutes before the CAM is activated. If a CAM is inserted and subscription fees are paid (subscription methods can differ), you can watch the scrambled channels supported by the CAM smart card. This TV is ready for the CI+ Conditional Access . With CI+ you can watch premium HD programmes, like movies and sports, offered by digital TV operators in your region. These programmes are scrambled by the TV operator and descrambled with a prepaid CI+ module. Digital TV operators provide a CI+ module (Conditional Access Module - CAM) and an accompanying smart card, when you subscribe to their premium programmes. These programmes have a high level of copy protection. The CAM and smart card are exclusively for your TV. If you remove the CAM, you will no longer be able to watch the scrambled channels supported by the CAM. Contact a digital TV operator for more information on terms & conditions. 25 If you cannot hear the sound from the TV on your Home Theatre System, check if you connected the HDMI cable to an HDMI ARC connection on the Home Theatre System. All HDMI connections on the TV are HDMI ARC connections. 6.3 Home Theatre System - HTS Connect with HDMI ARC Use an HDMI cable to connect a Home Theatre System (HTS) to the TV. You can connect a Philips Soundbar or an HTS with a built-in disc player. 6.4 Smartphones and Tablets HDMI ARC To connect a smartphone or tablet to the TV, you can use a wireless or wired connection. If your Home Theatre System has an HDMI ARC connection, you can use any HDMI connection on the TV to connect. With HDMI ARC, you do not need to connect the extra audio cable. The HDMI ARC connection combines both signals. All HDMI connections on the TV can offer the Audio Return Channel (ARC) signal. But once you have connected the Home Theatre System, the TV can only send the ARC signal to this HDMI connection. Wireless For a wireless connection, on your smartphone or tablet download the Philips TV Remote App from your favourite app store. Wired For a wired connection, use the HDMI 1 MHL connection on the back of the TV. Audio to video synchronisation (sync) If the sound does not match the video on screen, you can set a delay on most Home Theatre Systems with a disc player to match the sound with the video. 6.5 Blu-ray Disc Player Connect with HDMI Use a High speed HDMI cable to connect the Bluray Disc player to the TV. Use an HDMI cable to connect a Home Theatre System (HTS) to the TV. You can connect a Philips Soundbar or an HTS with a built-in disc player. If the Blu-ray Disc player has EasyLink HDMI CEC, you can operate the player with the TV remote control. If the Home Theatre System has no HDMI ARC connection, add an optical audio cable (Toslink) to send the sound of the TV picture to the Home Theatre System. In Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up EasyLink HDMI CEC for more information. 6.6 Audio to video synchronisation (sync) DVD Player If the sound does not match the video on screen, you can set a delay on most Home Theatre Systems with a disc player to match the sound with the video. Use an HDMI cable to connect the DVD player to the TV. If the DVD player is connected with HDMI and has EasyLink CEC, you can operate the player with the TV remote control. Problems with HTS sound For more information on EasyLink, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up EasyLink HDMI CEC. Sound with loud noise If you watch a video from a plugged in USB flash drive or connected computer, the sound from your Home Theatre System might be distorted. This noise is heard when the audio or video file has DTS sound but the Home Theatre System has no DTS sound processing. You can fix this by setting the Digital Out Format of the TV to Stereo. Y Pb Pr - Component Video is a high quality connection. The YPbPr connection can be used for High Definition (HD) TV signals. Press for All Settings > Sound > Advanced > Digital Ou t Format. No sound 26 Select a Device To select a wireless device… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Wireless and Networks and press OK. 3 - Select Bluetooth > Search for a device and press OK. 4 - In the list, select the wireless device and press OK. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Remove a Device You can connect or disconnect a wireless Bluetooth device. You can also remove a wireless Bluetooth device. If you remove a Bluetooth device, the device will be unpaired. 6.7 Bluetooth Pairing a Device To remove or disconnect a wireless device… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Wireless and Networks and press OK. 3 - Select Bluetooth > Remove Bluetooth device and press OK. 4 - In the list, select the wireless device and press OK. 5 - Select Disconnect or Remove and press OK. 6 - Select OK and press OK to confirm. 7 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Read the user manual of the device for specific information on pairing and on wireless range. Make sure the Bluetooth setting on TV is switched on. Once a wireless gamepad is paired, you can use it. When a device is paired, you do not need to pair it again unless you remove the device. To pair a bluetooth device with the TV… 1 - Switch on the bluetooth device and place it within range of the TV. 2 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 3 - Select Wireless and Networks and press (right) to enter the menu. 4 - Select Bluetooth > Search Bluetooth Device, and press OK. 5 - Select Start and press OK. Follow the instuctions on screen. You will pair the device with the TV and the TV will store the connection. You might need to unpair a paired device first if the maximum number of paired devices was reached. 6 - Select the type of device and press OK. 7 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 6.8 Headphones You can connect a set of headphones to the connection on the back of the TV. The connection is a mini-jack 3.5mm. You can adjust the volume of the headphones separately. To adjust the volume… 1 - Press , select Headphone Volume and press OK. 2 - Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the value. 3 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. * Your TV doesn't support Bluetooth subwoofer and Bluetooth speakers. ** HDMI connection is required for sound bar, speaker and other audio device. 27 6.9 6.10 Game Console USB Hard Drive HDMI What You Need For best quality, connect the game console with a High speed HDMI cable to the TV. If you connect a USB Hard Drive, you can pause or record digital TV broadcasts (DVB broadcasts or similar). Minimum Disk Space • To Pause To pause a broadcast, you need a USB 2.0 compatible Hard Drive with a minimum of 4GB disk space. • To Record To pause and record a broadcast, you need a minimum of 250GB disk space. For more information on how to install a USB Hard Drive, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up USB Hard Drive, installation. Installation Y Pb Pr Before you can pause or record a broadcast, you must connect and format a USB Hard Drive. Formatting removes all files from the USB Hard Drive. Connect the game console with a component video cable (Y Pb Pr) and an audio L/R cable to the TV. 1 - Connect the USB Hard Drive to one of the USB connections on the TV. Do not connect another USB device to the other USB ports when formatting. 2 - Switch on the USB Hard Drive and the TV. 3 - When the TV is tuned to a digital TV channel, press (Pause). Trying to pause will start the formatting. Follow the instructions on screen. When the USB Hard Drive is formatted, leave it connected permanently. 28 key Keywords and look up Recording, or Apps. Pause TV, 6.11 USB Keyboard Connect Connect a USB keyboard (USB-HID type) to enter text on your TV. Use one of the USB connections to connect. Configure Warning Install the keyboard The USB Hard Drive is formatted exclusively for this TV, you cannot use the stored recordings on another TV or PC. Do not copy or change recording files on the USB Hard Drive with any PC application. This will corrupt your recordings. When you format another USB Hard Drive, the content on the former will be lost. A USB Hard Drive installed on your TV will need reformatting for use with a computer. To install the USB keyboard, switch on the TV and connect the USB keyboard to one of the USB connections on the TV. When the TV detects the keyboard for the first time, you can select your keyboard lay-out and test your selection. If you select a Cyrillic or Greek keyboard layout first, you can select a secondary Latin keyboard layout. To change the keyboard layout setting when a layout was selected… Formatting 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select General Settings and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select USB Keyboard Settings, and press OK to start the keyboard setup. Before you can pause or record a broadcast, or store apps, you must connect and format a USB Hard Drive. Formatting removes all files from the USB Hard Drive. If you want to record broadcasts with TV Guide data from the Internet, you must setup the Internet connection first before you install the USB Hard Drive. Warning Special Keys The USB Hard Drive is formatted exclusively for this TV, you cannot use the stored recordings on another TV or PC. Do not copy or change recording files on the USB Hard Drive with any PC application. This will corrupt your recordings. When you format another USB Hard Drive, the content on the former will be lost. A USB Hard Drive installed on your TV will need reformatting for use with a computer. Keys for entering text • Enter key = OK • Backspace = delete character before cursor • Arrow keys = navigate within a text field • To switch between keyboard layouts, if a secondary layout is set, press the Ctrl + Spacebar keys simultaneously. Keys for apps and Internet pages • Tab and Shift + Tab = Next and Previous • Home = scroll to the top of the page • End = scroll to the bottom of the page • Page Up = jump one page up • Page Down = jump one page down • + = zoom in one step • - = zoom out one step • * = fit the web page to the screen width To format a USB Hard Drive… 1 - Connect the USB Hard Drive to one of the USB connections on the TV. Do not connect another USB device to the other USB ports when formatting. 2 - Switch on the USB Hard Drive and the TV. 3 - Select Recordings if you want to perform Pause TV and Recordings, otherwise, select Apps to store apps. Follow the instructions on screen. 4 - All files and data will be removed after formatting. 5 - When the USB Hard Drive is formatted, leave it connected permanently. For more information, in Help, press the colour 29 content with PTP (Picture Transfer Protocol). Read the user manual of the digital photo camera. 6.12 USB Flash Drive Ultra HD on USB You can view photos or play your music and videos from a connected USB flash drive. You can view photos in Ultra HD resolution from a connected USB device or flash drive. The TV will downscale the resolution to Ultra HD if the resolution of the photo is higher. You cannot play a native Ultra HD video on any of the USB connections. Insert a USB flash drive in one of the USB connections on the TV while the TV is switched on. For more information on viewing photos, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Photos, Videos and Music. The TV detects the flash drive and opens a list showing its content. If the contents list does not appear automatically, press SOURCES and select USB. 6.14 To stop watching the USB flash drive content, press EXIT or select another activity. To disconnect the USB flash drive, you can pull out the flash drive anytime. Camcorder For best quality, use an HDMI cable to connect the camcorder to the TV. Ultra HD on USB You can view photos in Ultra HD resolution from a connected USB device or flash drive. The TV will downscale the resolution to Ultra HD if the resolution of the photo is higher. You cannot play a native Ultra HD video on any of the USB connections. For more information on watching or playing content from a USB flash drive, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Photos, Videos and Music. 6.13 Photo Camera To view photos stored on your digital photo camera, you can connect the camera directly to the TV. 6.15 Computer Use one of the USB connections on the TV to connect. Switch on the camera after you made the connection. If the contents list does not appear automatically, press SOURCES , and select USB. Your camera might need to be set to transfer its 30 Connect You can connect your computer to the TV and use the TV as a PC monitor. With HDMI Use an HDMI cable to connect the computer to the TV. With DVI to HDMI Alternatively, you can use a DVI to HDMI adapter (sold separately) to connect the PC to HDMI and an audio L/R cable (mini-jack 3.5mm) to AUDIO IN L/R on the back of the TV. Ideal Setting If you connect a computer, we advice you to give the connection, on which the computer is connected, the correct device type name in the Source menu. If you then switch to Computer in the Source menu, the TV is set to the ideal Computer setting automatically. To set the TV to the ideal setting… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Picture and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Advanced > Computer, and press OK. 4 - Select On or Off, and press OK. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 31 devices in your wireless network that use the WEP security encryption system, you cannot use WPS. 7 Connect your Android TV 1 - Go to the router, press the WPS button and return to the TV within 2 minutes. 2 - Select Connect to make the connection. 3 - A message will be shown when the connection is successful. 7.1 Network and Internet Make the Connection - WPS with PIN Code Home Network (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Connect to Network > WPS with PIN Code. To enjoy the full capabilities of your Philips Android TV, your TV must be connected to the Internet. If your router has WPS with a PIN code, you can directly connect to the router without scanning for networks. If you have devices in your wireless network that use the WEP security encryption system, you cannot use WPS. Connect the TV to a home network with a high-speed Internet connection. You can connect your TV wirelessly or wired to your network router. 1 - Write down the 8-digit PIN code shown on screen and enter it in the router software on your PC. Consult the router manual on where to enter the PIN code in the router software. 2 - Select Connect to make the connection. 3 - A message will be shown when the connection is successful. Connect to Network Wireless Connection What You Need To connect the TV to the Internet wirelessly, you need a Wi-Fi router with a connection to the Internet. Use a high-speed (broadband) connection to the Internet. Problems Wireless network not found or distorted • Microwave ovens, DECT phones or other Wi-Fi 802.11b/g/n devices in your proximity might disturb the wireless network. • Make sure that the firewalls in your network allow access to the TV's wireless connection. • If the wireless network does not work properly in your home, try the wired network installation. Make the Connection Make the Connection - Wireless (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Connect to Network > Wireless. Internet does not work • If the connection to the router is OK, check the router connection to the Internet. 1 - In the list of found networks, select on your wireless network. If your network is not in the list because the network name is hidden (you switched off the SSID broadcast of the router), select Add New Network to enter the network name yourself. 2 - Depending on the type of router, enter your encryption key - WEP, WPA or WPA2. If you entered the encryption key for this network before, you can select OK to make the connection immediately. 3 - A message will be shown when the connection is successful. The PC and Internet connection are slow • Look in your wireless router's user manual for information on indoor range, transfer rate and other factors of signal quality. • Use a high-speed (broadband) Internet connection for your router. DHCP • If the connection fails, you can check the DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) setting of the router. DHCP should be switched on. In Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Troubleshooting for more information. Make the Connection - WPS (TV menu) > Settings > Wireless and Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Connect to Network > WPS. If your router has WPS, you can directly connect to the router without scanning for networks. If you have 32 Wired Connection Network Configuration - Static IP Configuration What You Need (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Network Configuration > Static IP Configuration. To connect the TV to the Internet, you need a network router with a connection to the Internet. Use a high-speed (broadband) connection to the Internet. 1 - Select Static IP Configuration and configure the connection. 2 - You can set the number for IP Address, Netmask, Gateway, DNS 1, or DNS 2. Switch On with Wi-Fi (WoWLAN) (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Switch On with Wi-Fi (WoWLAN). You can switch this TV on from your smartphone or tablet if the TV is in Standby. The setting Switch On with Wi-Fi (WoWLAN) must be switched on. Switch on Wi-Fi connection (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi On/Off. Make the Connection (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Connect to Network > Wired. You can switch on or off Wi-Fi connection on your TV. 1 - Connect the router to the TV with a network cable (Ethernet cable**). 2 - Make sure that the router is switched on. 3 - The TV constantly searches for the network connection. 4 - A message will be shown when the connection is successful. Digital Media Renderer - DMR (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Digital Media Renderer - DMR. If your media files do not play on your TV, make sure that the Digitial Media Renderer is switched on. As a factory setting, DMR is switched on. If the connection fails, you can check the DHCP setting of the router. DHCP should be switched on. **To fulfill EMC regulations, use a shielded FTP Cat. 5E Ethernet cable. TV Network Name (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > TV Network Name. Network Settings If you have more than one TV in your home network, you can give the TV a unique name. View Network Settings (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > View Network Settings. Clear Internet Memory You can view all current network settings here. The IP and MAC address, signal strength, speed, encryption method, etc. (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Clear Internet Memory. With Clear Internet Memory you clear your Philips server registration and parental rating settings, your video store app logins, all Philips App Gallery favourites, Internet bookmarks and history. Interactive MHEG applications can also save so-called 'cookies', on your TV. These files will also be cleared. Network Configuration - Static IP (TV menu) > Settings > Networks > Wired or Wi-Fi > Network Configuration > Static IP. If you are an advanced user and want to install your network with Static IP addressing, set the TV to Static IP. 33 7.2 Google Account Sign In To enjoy the full capabilities of your Philips Android TV, you can sign in to Google with your Google Account. By signing in you'll be able to play your favourite games across phone, tablet and TV. You'll also get customised video and music recommendations on your TV home screen as well as access to YouTube, Google Play and other apps. Sign In Use your existing Google Account to sign in to Google on your TV. A Google Account consists of an email address and a password. If you don't have an Google Account yet, use your computer or tablet to create one (accounts.google.com). To play games with Google Play, you need a Google+ profile. If you did not sign in during the first TV installation, you can always sign in later. To sign in after you did the TV installation… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Android Settings and press OK. 3 - Press (down) and select Personal > Add account and press OK. 4 - Press OK on SIGN IN. 5 - With the on-screen keyboard, enter your email address and press OK. 6 - Enter your password and press the same small OK key to sign in. 7 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. If you want to sign in with another Google Account, first sign out and sign in with the other account. Android Settings You can set or view several Android specific settings or information. You can find the list of apps installed on your TV and the storage space they need. You can set the language you like to use with Voice Search. You can configure the onscreen keyboard or allow apps to use your location. Explore the different Android settings. You can go to www.support.google.com/androidtv for more information on these settings. To open these settings… 1234- Press , select All Settings and press OK. Select Android Settings, and press OK. Explore the different Android settings. Press BACK if necessary, to close the menu. 34 8 repeatedly or press EXIT. Apps Some Google Play products and features aren't available in all countries. 8.1 Find more information on support.google.com/androidtv About Apps You can find all installed apps in the Apps section of the Home menu. Music Like apps on your smartphone or tablet, the apps on your TV offer specific functions for an enriched TV experience. Apps like YouTube, games, video stores or weather forecasts (a.o.). You can use the Internet app to surf the Internet. With Google Play Music, you can play your favourite music on TV. With Google Play Music you can buy new music on your computer or mobile device. Or, on your TV, you can sign up for All Access, the Google Play Music subscription. Alternatively, you can play the music you already own, stored on your computer. Apps can come from the Philips App Gallery or the Google Play™ Store . To get you started, some practical apps are pre-installed on your TV. What You Need • your TV must be connected with the Internet • you must sign in with your Google Account on TV • add a credit card to your Google Account to take a music subscription To install apps from the Philips App Gallery or the Google Play Store, the TV must be connected to the Internet. You must agree to the Terms of Use to use apps from the App Gallery. You must sign in with a Google Account to use the Google Play apps and Google Play Store. To start Google Play Music… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play Music and press OK. 3 - Select the music you want and press OK. 4 - To stop the Music app, press BACK repeatedly or press EXIT. 8.2 Google Play Movies and TV Some Google Play products and features aren't available in all countries. With Google Play Movies & TV, you can rent or buy movies and TV shows to watch on TV. Find more information on support.google.com/androidtv What You Need • your TV must be connected with the Internet • you must sign in with your Google Account on TV • add a credit card to your Google Account to purchase movies and TV shows Games With Google Play Games, you can play games on TV. Online or offline. To rent or buy a movie or TV show… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play Movies & TV and press OK. 3 - Select a movie or TV show and press OK. 4 - Select the purchase you want and press OK. You will be taken through the purchase procedure. You can see what your friends are playing currently or you can join the game and compete. You can track your achievements or start wherever you left off. What You Need • your TV must be connected with the Internet • you must sign in with your Google Account on TV • add a credit card to your Google Account to purchase new games To watch a rented or bought movie or TV show… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play Movies & TV and press OK. 3 - Select the movie or TV show from your library in the app, select the titel and press OK. 4 - You can use the (stop), (pause), (rewind) or (fast forward) keys on the remote control. 5 - To stop the Movies & TV app, press BACK Start the Google Play Games app to select and install new game apps on your TV. Some games are free of charge. A message appears if a particular game needs a gamepad to play the game. To start or stop a Google Play Game… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play 35 Games and press OK. 3 - Select a game to play or select a new game to install and press OK. 4 - When done, press BACK repeatedly or press EXIT or stop the app with its dedicated exit/stop button. Payments To make a payment on Google Play on TV, you must add a form of payment - a credit card (outside the United States) - to your Google Account. When you purchase a movie or TV show, you will be charged on this credit card. The games you install will also appear in the row of Games in the Home menu To add a credit card … Some Google Play products and features aren't available in all countries. 1 - On your computer, go to accounts.google.com and sign in with the Google Account you will use with Google Play on TV. 2 - Go to wallet.google.com to add a card to your Google Account. 3 - Enter your credit card data and accept the terms and conditions. Find more information on support.google.com/androidtv Google Play Store From the Google Play Store you can download and install new apps. Some apps are free of charge. 8.3 App Gallery What You Need • your TV must be connected with the Internet • you must sign in with your Google Account on TV • add a credit card to your Google Account to purchase apps Connect the TV to the Internet to enjoy apps selected by Philips. These apps are made specially for TV. The Philips App Gallery offers a wide diversity of apps. For some countries, you can install apps of a local Videostore or apps from TV broadcasters in your country. The latter can offer Catch-Up TV services. Downloading and installing App Gallery apps is free of charge. To install a new app… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play Store and press OK. 3 - Select the app you want to install and press OK. 4 - To close the Google Play Store, press BACK repeatedly or press EXIT. The Philips App Gallery collection of apps can differ per country or region. Some App Gallery apps are pre-installed on your TV. To install other apps from the App Gallery, you will be asked to agree to the Terms of Use. You can set the Privacy Settings according to your preference. Parental controls In the Google Play Store, you can hide apps according to users/buyers maturity. You need to enter a PIN code to select or change the level of maturity. To install an app from the App Gallery… To set the parental control… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Philips Collection > App Gallery and press OK. 3 - Select an app icon and press OK. 4 - Select Install and press OK. 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Google Play Store and press OK. 3 - Select Settings > Parental controls and press OK. 4 - Select the level of maturity you want. 5 - On request, enter the PIN code. 6 - To close the Google Play Store, press BACK repeatedly or press EXIT. 8.4 Start or Stop an App Some Google Play products and features aren't available in all countries. You can start an app from the Home menu. Find more information on support.google.com/androidtv 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down to Apps and select the app you want and press OK. 3 - To stop an app, press BACK or press EXIT or stop the app with its dedicated exit/stop button. To start an app… 36 Lock Apps • Purchase through Google Play Movies & TV, nor Google Play Games • Use third-party apps that don't use the Google signin About App Locks With the TV switched to a restricted profile you can… 8.5 • Watch content already rented or purchased from Google Play Movies & TV • Play games already purchased and installed from Google Play Games • Access the following settings: Wi-Fi network, Speech and Accessibility • Add Bluetooth accessories You can lock apps unsuited for children. You can lock 18+ rated apps from the App Gallery or set up a restricted profile in the Home menu. 18+ The 18+ app lock will ask for a PIN code when you try to start an 18+ rated app. This lock is only valid for 18+ rated apps from the Philips App Gallery. The Google Account on TV will stay logged in. Using a restricted profile doesn't change the Google Account. Restricted profile You can set up a restructed profile for the Home menu where only the apps you allow are available. You need to enter a PIN code to set up and switch on the restricted profile. Set Up To set up the restricted profile… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Android Settings and press OK. 3 - Press (down) and select Personal > Security & restrictions and press OK. 4 - Select Restricted Profile and press OK. 5 - Select Settings and press OK. 6 - Enter a PIN code with the remote control. 7 - Select Allowed apps and press OK. 8 - In the list of available apps, select an app and press OK to allow or not allow this app. 9 - Press BACK to go back one step or press EXIT to close the menu. Google Play Store - Maturity In the Google Play Store, you can hide apps according to users/buyers maturity. You need to enter a PIN code to select or change the level of maturity. The level of maturity will determine which apps are available for instalation. Lock 18+ rated apps You can lock 18+ rated apps from the Philips App Gallery. This setting controls the 18+ setting in the Philips App Gallery Privacy Settings. Now you can enter the restricted profile. To lock 18+ rated apps… With the PIN code, you can always change the PIN code or edit the list of allowed or not allowed apps. 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Child Lock, select App Lock and press OK. 3 - Select On and press OK. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Enter To enter (switch to) the restricted profile… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Android Settings and press OK. 3 - Press (down) and select Personal > Security & restrictions and press OK. 4 - Select Enter restricted profile and press OK. 5 - Enter a PIN code with the remote control. 6 - Press BACK to go back one step or press EXIT to close the menu. For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Child Lock, App Lock for more information. Restricted Profile About Restricted Profile You can restrict the use of certain apps by switching the TV to a restricted profile. The Home menu will only show the apps you allowed. You need a PIN code to switch out of the restricted profile. You can see when a restricted profile is entered if an icon appears in the Home screen. Scroll down to Settings and scroll to the far right. With the TV switched to a restricted profile you cannot… • Find or open apps which are marked as Not allowed • Access the Google Play Store 37 Exit To exit the restricted profile… 1 - Press HOME, scroll down to Settings and scroll far right. 2 - Select Restricted Profile and press OK. 3 - Select Exit restricted profile and press OK. 4 - Enter the PIN code. The TV will exit the restricted profile. 8.6 Manage Apps If you stop an app and return to the Home menu, the app is not really stopped. The app is still running in the background to be readily available when you start it again. To run fluently, most apps need to save some data in the cache memory of the TV. It might be good to stop an app completely or clear the cache data of a particular app to optimise the overall performance of apps and to keep memory usage low on your Android TV. Also, it is best to uninstall apps that you are not using anymore. 8.7 Storage You can see how much storage space - the internal TV memory - you are using for your apps, videos, music, etc. You can see how much free space you still have available for installing new apps. Check your storage if apps start to run slow or in case of app trouble. To see how much storage you are using… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Android Settings and press OK. 3 - Select Device > Storage & reset and press OK. 4 - View the storage usage of the TV memory. 5 - Press BACK to go back one step or press EXIT to close the menu. USB Hard Drive If you connect a USB Hard Drive, you can use the drive to extent the TV memory to store more apps. Allow the USB Hard Drive to be used as an additional TV memory during the formatting process. The TV will try to store new apps on the USB Hard Drive first. Some apps do not allow to be stored on a USB Hard Drive. To migrate your existing data, go to All Settings > Android Settings > Device> Storage & reset and select the USB Hard Drive. 38 9 Internet 9.1 Start Internet You can browse the Internet on your TV. You can view any Internet website but most of them are not prepared for a TV screen. • Some plug-ins (e.g. to view pages or videos) are not available on your TV. • You cannot send or download files. • Internet pages are shown one page at a time and full screen. To start the Internet browser… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Scroll down and select Apps > Internet and press OK. 3 - Enter an Internet address and select , press OK. 4 - To close Internet, press HOME or EXIT. 9.2 Options on Internet Some extras are available for the Internet. To open the extras… 1 - With the website open, press OPTIONS. 2 - Select one of the items and press OK. • Add to speed dial: To enter a new Internet address. • Add to bookmarks: Add the page as bookmark • Page security: To view the security level of the current page. • New private tab: Open new private tab, and have private browsing • Settings: Settings for Zoom, Text size, Accessibility mode, Always show menu bar, and clear (browsing) history • Help: Internet browser information • Exit Internet browser: Close Internet browser 39 10 TV Menu 10.1 About TV Menu If the TV cannot be connected with the Internet, you can use the TV Menu as your Home menu. In the TV Menu, you will find every TV function. 10.2 Open TV Menu To open TV Menu and open an item… 1 - Press to open TV Menu. 2 - Select an item and press OK to open or start it. 3 - Press BACK to close TV Menu without starting anything. 40 11 11.3 Sources Device Name and Type When you connect a new device to the TV and the TV detects the device, you can assign an icon that fits the device type. If you connect a device with an HDMI cable and HDMI CEC, the TV detects the device type automatically and the device gets an appropriate icon. 11.1 Switch to a device From the list of Sources, you can switch to any of the connected devices. You can switch to a tuner to watch TV, open the content of a connected USB Flash Drive or see the recordings you made on a connected USB Hard Drive. You can switch to your connected devices to watch their programme, a digital receiver or a Blu-ray Disc player. The device type determines picture and sound styles, resolution values, specific settings or the position within the Sources menu. You don't have to worry about the ideal settings. Rename or Change Type To switch to a connected device… You can always change the name or change the type of a connected device. Look for the icon at the right of the device name in the Sources menu. Some TV input sources do not allow a name change. 1 - Press SOURCES to open the Sources menu. 2 - Select one of the item in the source list and press OK. The TV will show the programme or content of the device. 3 - Press SOURCES again to close the menu. One Touch Play To change the device type… 1 - Select the device in the Sources menu. 2 - Press (right) to select the icon and press OK. 3 - Press BACK to hide the on-screen keyboard. 4 - Press (down) to find all available device types. Select the type you want and press OK. With the TV in standby, you can switch on a disc player with your TV remote control. To switch on both disc player and TV from standby and start playing the disc immediately, press (play) on the TV remote control. The device must be connected with an HDMI cable and both TV and device must have HDMI CEC switched on. 5 - If you want to reset the type of the device to the original connector type, select Reset and press OK. 6 - Select Close and press OK to close this menu. 11.2 To change the device name… Options for a TV Input 1 - Select the device in the Sources menu. 2 - Press (right) to select the icon and press OK. 3 - Use the on-screen Keyboard to delete the current name and enter a new one. Press to confirm. 4 - Press BACK to hide the on-screen keyboard. 5 - If you want to reset the name of the device to the original connector name, select Reset and press OK. 6 - Select Close and press OK to close this menu. Some TV input devices offer specific settings. To set the options for a specific TV input… 1 - Press SOURCES. 2 - Select the TV input in the list and press OK. 3 - Press OPTIONS. You can set the options for the selected TV input here. 4 - Press OPTIONS again to close the Options menu. Possible options… Controls 11.4 With this option you can operate the connected device with the TV remote control. The device must be connected with an HDMI cable and both TV and device must have HDMI CEC switched on. Rescan Connections Device Info To rescan the connections… Open this option to view information on the connected device. 1 - Press SOURCES to open the Sources menu. 2 - Press (up) to select the icon at the top right of the Sources menu. 3 - Press OK to start scanning the connections. Newly connected devices will be added to the You can rescan all TV connections to update the Sources menu with recently connected devices. 41 Sources menu. 42 12 Networks 12.1 Network For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Network, for more information on connecting the TV to a network. 12.2 Bluetooth Pairing a Device For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Bluetooth, Pairing for more information on pairing wireless devices. Remove a Device For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up Bluetooth, Remove device for more information on how to unpair (remove) a wireless Bluetooth device. Bluetooth On or Off To connect wireless Bluetooth devices, make sure Bluetooth is switched on. To switch Bluetooth on… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Wireless and Networks and press OK. 3 - Select Bluetooth > Bluetooth On/Off and press OK. 4 - Select On or Off and press OK. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. 43 colour saturation value of the picture. 13 Settings Adjust the picture contrast 13.1 (TV menu) > Picture Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the contrast value of the picture. Picture Settings You can decrease contrast value to reduce power consumption. Settings > Picture > Contrast. Picture Style Select a style (TV menu) > style. Adjust the picture sharpness Settings > Picture > Picture (TV menu) > For easy picture adjustment, you can select a preset picture style. Settings > Picture > Sharpness. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the sharpness value of the picture. • Personal - The picture preferences you set during the first start up. • Vivid - Ideal for daylight viewing • Natural - Natural picture settings • Standard - Most energy conscious setting Factory setting • Movie - Ideal for watching movies • Game - Ideal for playing games • Day - For ISF Calibration • Night - For ISF Calibration Adjust brightness (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Brightness. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to set the level of brightness of the picture signal. Note: Setting of brightness much away from reference value (50) may result lower contrast. When TV receives HDR signal, select a picture style below: • HDR Personal • HDR Vivid • HDR Natural • HDR Movie • HDR Game • Day - For ISF Calibration • Night - For ISF Calibration Advanced Picture Settings Restore a Style 1 - Select the picture style you want to restore. 2 - Press the colour key Restore style, and press OK. The style is restored. Set to On to have the ideal picture setting for use your TV as a computer monitor. Computer Setting (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Computer . Colour Settings Customise a Style Advanced Colour Settings Any picture setting you adjust, like Colour or Contrast, is stored in the currently selected Picture Style. It allows you to customise each style. Only the style Personal can save its settings for each source in the Sources menu. (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour. Adjust the colour enhancement (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour > Colou r enhancement. Colour, Contrast, Sharpness, Brightness Adjust the picture colour (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Colour. Press the arrows (up) or Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to set the level of the colour intensity and the details in bright (down) to adjust the 44 colours. all to reset all value to default. Select the preset colour temperature RGB only mode (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour > Colour temp erature. (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour > RGB only mode. Select Normal, Warm, or Cool to set the colour temperature for your preference. Select Red, Green, or Blue to switch picture as selected colour only, or select Off to turn off RGB mode. Customise colour temperature (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour > Custom Colo ur temperature. Advanced Contrast Settings Select Custom in Colour temperature menu to customise a colour temperature yourself. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the value. WP is white point and BL is black level. You can also select one of the presets in this menu. (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > Cont rast mode. Contrast Modes Select Normal, Optimized for picture, or Optimized for energy savings to set the TV automatically reduces the contrast, for best power consumption or for best picture experience, or select Off to switch off the adjustment. ISF Colour Settings About ISF Get the most out of your TV display with ISF® Calibration. Ask a ISF calibration expert to come to your home and set the TV to the most optimal picture setting. Ask your dealer for an ISF Calibration. HDR Settings If you are watching HDR programmes - programmes recorded in HDR - there is no need to upscale to HDR and the HDR setting is unavailable. The TV can play HDR programmes from a HDMI connection, from an Internet source or from a connected USB memory device. Calibration benefits are… • better picture clarity and sharpness • better detail in bright and dark parts • deeper and darker blacks • better colour purity and quality • optmise the picture viewing effect in your home for both daylight and night conditions If you are watching HDR (High-Dynamic Range) programmes - programmes recorded in HDR - The TV will automatically switched to HDR mode with indication. The ISF Calibration expert stores and locks the ISF settings as two picture styles. When the ISF Calibration is done, press (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Picture Style > Day or Night. Select Day to watch TV during bright light conditions or select Night when it's dark. HDR Upscaling control is unavailable. The TV can play HDR programmes* from HDMI 1 or HDMI 2 connection, broadcasting, from an Internet source or from a connected USB memory device. * Only HDR10 and Hybrid Log Gamma HDR are supported Colour control (Hue, Saturation) HDR Upscalling (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Colour > Colour control. (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > HDR upscalling. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the value of Hue and Saturation, or select Reset Select On to boost the brightness and contrast of the picture. The picture is much brighter and has a 45 higher level of contrast between lighter and darker parts. HDR upscaling keeps colours rich and saturated. Ultra Resolution (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Sharpness > Ult ra Resolution. Note: • Available when SDR (Standard Dynamic Range) signal is detected. • Not available when video content is supported HDR. Select On to have a superior sharpness in line edges and details. HDR Perfect Picture Clean (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > HDR Perfect. Noise reduction (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Picture clean > Noise reduction. Select HDR Perfect for superior contrast and brightness effect. Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to set the level for removing the noise in video content. Noise is mostly visible as small moving dots in onscreen picture. Note: Available when HDR (High-Dynamic Range) signal is detected. Perfect Contrast MPEG Artefact Reduction (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > Perf ect contrast. (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Picture clean > MPEG Artefact Reduction. Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to set the level at which the TV automatically enhances the details in the dark, middle and light areas of the picture. Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to have different degress of smoothing the artefects in digital video content. MPEG artefacts are mostly visible as small blocks or jagged edges in on-screen images. Video Contrast, Gamma Video contrast Motion Settings (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > Vide o contrast. Press the arrows (up) or video contrast level. Motion Styles (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Motion > Motio n styles. (down) to adjust the Motion styles provides optimised motion setting modes for different video content. Gamma Select one of the motion styles to have better viewing experience. (Movie, Sports, Standard, Smooth, Personal) (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Contrast > Gam ma. Not available for below cases: • (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Computer set to On. • (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Picture style > Game. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to set a nonlinear setting for picture luminance and contrast. 46 stopped and will be restarted automatically when the TV switches to standby at a later time. While processing, a white line may appear on the screen. This is normal when clearing on-screen image retention. Natural Motion (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Motion > Natur al Motion. Natural Motion makes any movement smooth and fluent. Picture Format Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to have different degress for reducing the motion judder, visible in movies on TV. Select Minimum or Off when noise appears in playing moving picture on-screen. If the picture is not filling the whole screen, if black bars are showing on the top or bottom or at both sides, you can adjust the picture to fill the screen completely. To select one of the basic settings to fill the screen… Note: Only available when Motion styles set to Personal. 1 - While watching a TV channel, press . 2 - Select Picture Format > Fill Screen, Fit to Screen, Wide Screen and Original, and press OK. 3 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. • Fill Screen – automatically enlarges the picture to fill the screen. Picture distortion is minimal, subtitles remain visible. Not suitable for PC input. Some extreme picture formats can still show black bars. • Fit to Screen – automatically zooms in the picture to fill the screen without distortion. Black bars may be visible. Not suitable for PC input. • Wide Screen – automatically zooms in the picture to wide screen. • Original – automatically zooms in the picture to wide screen. Perfect Clear Motion* (TV menu) > Settings > Picture > Advanced > Motion > Perfe ct Clear Motion. Perfect Clear Motion makes any movement smooth and fluent. Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to have different degress for reducing the motion judder, visible in movies on TV. Select Minimum or Off when noise appears in playing moving picture on-screen. To format the picture manually… Note: Only available when Motion styles set to Personal. 1 - While watching a TV channel, press . 2 - Select Advanced and press OK. 3 - Use Shift, Zoom, and Stretch to adjust the picture. 4 - Or select Undo to return to the setting the picture had when you opened Picture Format. • Shift – Select on the arrows to shift the picture. You can only shift the picture when it is zoomed in. • Zoom – Select on the arrows to zoom in. • Stretch – Select on the arrows to stretch the picture vertically or horizontally. • Undo – Select to return to the picture format you started with. * Only for 7502/8102/8602/9002 series Clear Image Residual Displaying a still image for a prolonged period of time may cause an image sticking. This phenomenon is normal character for OLED panel. Avoid displaying a fixed image on the TV screen for an extended length of time. Or you can clear such image retention on-screen by activating this function. 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Picture and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Advanced > Clear Image Residual. 4 - Select Confirm. Quick Picture Setting During the first installation, you did some picture settings in a few easy steps. You can redo these steps with Quick Picture Setting. To do these steps, make sure the TV can tune to a TV channel or can show a programme from a connected device. The TV will be switched off until the process is completed. If you are recording something, the process will be paused, and restart until the recording is completed. It might take more than 1 hour. If you turn the TV on during the process, it will be To set the picture in a few easy steps… 47 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Picture and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Quick Picture Setting, and press OK. 4 - Use the navigation keys to select your choice. 5 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. volume of a connected headphone separately. 13.2 Advanced Sound Settings Sound Volume Control Sound Style Auto volume levelling Switch on surround sound effect (TV menu) > sound > On. (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Auto volume levelling. Select a style (TV menu) > style. Settings > Sound > Sound Select On to automatically level out sudden volume differences. Typically when you are switching channels. For easy sound adjustment, you can select a preset setting with sound style. • Personal - The sound preferences you set during the first start up. • Original - Most neutral sound setting • Movie - Ideal for watching movies • Music - Ideal for listening to music • Game - Ideal for gaming • News - Ideal for speech Delta volume (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Delta volume. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the delta value for TV speaker volume. Restore a Style 1 - Select the sound style you want to restore. 2 - Press the colour key Restore Style, and press OK. The style is restored. Audio Out Settings (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Audio out. Bass, Treble, Headphone Volume, Surround Sound Set the TV to play the sound on TV or on the connected audio system. Bass (TV menu) > You can select where you want to hear the TV sound and how you want to control it. • If you select TV Speakers Off, you permanently switch off the TV speakers. • If you select TV Speakers, the TV speakers are always on. Settings > Sound > Bass. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the level of low tones in the sound. Treble (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Surround With an audio device connected with HDMI CEC, select HDMI sound system. The TV will switch off the TV speakers when the device is playing the sound. Settings > Sound > Treble. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the level of high tones in the sound. Headphone volume (TV menu) > volume. Clear Dialogue Settings > Sound > Headphone Press the arrows (up) or (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Clear dialogue. (down) to adjust the 48 menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Digital out offset. Select On to improve the sound for speech. Ideal for news programmes. If you cannot set a delay on the Home Theatre System, you can set the TV to sync the sound. You can set an offset that compensates for the time necessary for the Home Theatre System to process the sound of the TV picture. You can set the value in steps of 5ms. Maximum setting is 60ms. Digital Output Settings Digital output settings are available for optical and HDMI ARC sound signals. Digital out format (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Digital out format. TV placement Set the audio out signal of the TV to fit the sound capabilities of the connected Home Theatre System. (TV menu) > placement. • Stereo: If your audio playback devices have no multichannel sound processing, select to only output stereo content to your audio playback devices. • Multichannel: Select to only output 5.1 audio content (compressed multichannel sound signal) to your audio playback devices. • Multichannel (bypass): Select to output Dolby Digital Plus or DTS content to your audio playback devices or Home theatre system. Settings > Sound > TV Select On a TV stand or On the wall to have best sound reproduction according to the setting. 13.3 Ambilight Settings Turn Ambilight On or Off - Make sure your audio playback devices support Dolby Atmos feature. Turn off Ambilight - SPDIF output (DIGITAL AUDIO OUT) will be disabled when streaming Dolby Digital Plus content. Press AMBILIGHT and select Off, or you can turn Off by pressing (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight style > Off. Digital out levelling (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Digital out levelling. Ambilight Style You can select the way Ambilight follows. Adjust the loudness level from device which is connected to digital audio output (SPDIF) or HDMI. (TV menu) > style. • Select More to have louder volume. • Select Less to have softer volume. Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight Follow Video Digital out delay (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight style > Follow video. (TV menu) > Settings > Sound > Advanced > Digital out delay. Select one of the styles that follow the dynamics of the picture on your TV screen. For some Home Theatre Systems you might need to adjust the audio sync delay to synchronise the audio to the video. Select Off if a sound delay is set on your Home Theatre System. • Standard - Ideal for day to day TV watching • Natural - Follows the picture or sound as truthful as possible • Immersive - Ideal for action movies • Vivid - Ideal for daylight conditions • Game - Ideal for gaming • Comfort - Ideal for a quiet evening • Relax - Ideal for a lounge feeling Digital out offset (Only available when Digital out delay set to On) (TV 49 Ambilight + Hue Follow Audio Configure (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight style > Follow audio. (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > Configure. Select one of the styles that follow the dynamics of the sound. • Lumina - Mixes audio dynamics with video colours • Colora - Based on audio dynamics • Retro - Based on audio dynamics • Spectrum - Based on audio dynamics • Scanner - Based on audio dynamics • Rhytm - Based on audio dynamics • Party - A mix of all Follow Audio styles, one after the other Switch Off Switch off Ambilight+hue (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > Switch off. Follow Colour Immersion (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight style > Follow colour. (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > Immersio n. Select one of the preset colour styles. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust how accurate the Hue bulbs follow the Ambilight. • Hot lava - Red colour variations • Deep water - Blue colour variations • Fresh nature - Green colour variations • warm white - Static colour • Cool white - Static colour Lounge Light+hue If you installed Ambilight+hue, you can let the hue bulbs follow Lounge Light from Ambilight. The Philips hue lamps will expand the Lounge Light effect across the room. Follow App (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight style > Follow app. Switch on/off the hue bulbs (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > Lounge light+hue. This function is available when you control Ambilight with an app. Ambilight Brightness, Saturation Brightness View Configuration or Reset (TV menu) > View current setup of the Ambilight+hue, network, Settings > Ambilight > Brightness. Bridge and bulbs Press the arrows (up) or (down) to set the level of Ambilight brightness. (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > View configuration. Saturation (TV menu) > Reset current setup of the Ambilight+hue Settings > Ambilight > Saturation. (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Ambilight+hue > Reset configuration. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to set the level of Ambilight saturation. 50 surrounding light darkens. The built-in light sensor automatically adjusts the picture, to the lighting conditions of the room. Advanced Ambilight Settings Neutralise the influence of a coloured wall on the Set TV switch off timer Ambilight colours (TV menu) > Settings > Eco settings > Switch off timer. (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Advanced > Wall colour. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the value. The value 0 (Off) deactivates the automatic switch off. Select the colour of the wall behind the TV and the TV will modify the Ambilight colours to appear as they are intended. Select Switch off timer, the TV switches off automatically to save energy. * TV switches off if receiving a TV signal but you don't press a key on the remote control during a 4 hour period. ISF Tuning (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Advanced > * TV switches off if not receivING a TV signal nor a remote control command for 10 minutes. ISF tuning. * If you use the TV as a monitor or use a digital receiver to watch TV (a Set-Top Box - STB) and you do not use the remote control of the TV, you should deactivate this automatic switch off, to set the value to 0. Set Ambilight to switch off immediately or slowly fade out when you switch off the TV (TV menu) > Settings > Ambilight > Advanced > TV switch off. 13.5 General Settings EasyLink - HDMI CEC 13.4 Eco Settings Connect HDMI CEC-compatible devices to your TV, you can operate them with the TV remote control. Set energy saving level EasyLink HDMI CEC must be switched on on the TV and the connected device. (TV menu) > Settings > Eco settings > Energy saving. Switch on EasyLink Select Maximum, Medium, or Minimum to have different degress for energy saving, or select Off to switch off energy saving mode. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > EasyLink > EasyLink > On. Operate HDMI CEC-compatible devices with TV Set screen off to save energy consumption remote control (TV menu) > Settings > Eco settings > Screen off. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > EasyLink > EasyLink remote control > On. Select Screen off, the TV screen is switched off, to switch the TV screen back on, press any key on the remote control. Note: • EasyLink might not work with devices from other brands. • The HDMI CEC functionality has different names on different brands. Some examples are: Anynet, Aquos Link, Bravia Theatre Sync, Kuro Link, Simplink and Viera Link. Not all brands are fully compatible with EasyLink. Example HDMI CEC branding names are Switch on built-in ambient light sensor (TV menu) > Settings > Eco settings > Light sensor. Select Light sensor, the built-in ambient light sensor lowers the brightness of the TV screen when the 51 property of their respective owners. 2 - Switch on the USB Hard Drive and the TV. 3 - Select Recordings if you want to perform Pause TV and Recordings, otherwise, select Apps to store apps. Follow the instructions on screen. 4 - All files and data will be removed after formatting. 5 - When the USB Hard Drive is formatted, leave it connected permanently. HDMI Ultra HD Connect the HDMI device and play Ultra HD signal on your TV, might not work correctly or show distorted picture or sound. To avoid the malfunctioning of such a device, you can set the signal quality to a level the device can handle. USB Keyboard Settings Set the signal quality for each HDMI connectors Set the keyboard layout for installed USB keyboard (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > HDMI Ultra HD > HDMI 1&2 > UHD 4:2:0, UHD 4:4:4/4:2:2. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > USB keyboard settings. The setting UHD 4:4:4/4:2:2 allows UHD YCbCr 4:4:4 / 4:2:2 signals. The setting UHD 4:2:0 allows UHD YCbCr 4:2:0 signals. Connect the USB keyboard to one of the USB connections on this TV. When the TV detects the keyboard for the first time, you can select your keyboard lay-out and test your selection. If the device is not using Ultra HD signals, you can switch off Ultra HD for this HDMI connection. CAM Profile Name Set the signal quality for each HDMI connectors (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > HDMI Ultra HD > HDMI 1&2 > UHD Off. Set profile name for installed CI+/CAM USB Hard Drive HbbTV Settings - Hybrid Broadcast Broadband TV (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > CAM profile name. You need to set up and format a USB Hard Drive before you record a channel. Switch on HbbTV (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > USB Hard Drive. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > HbbTV settings > HbbTV > On. Before you can pause or record a broadcast, or store apps, you must connect and format a USB Hard Drive. Formatting removes all files from the USB Hard Drive. If you want to record broadcasts with TV Guide data from the Internet, you must setup the Internet connection first before you install the USB Hard Drive. Switch off HbbTV History Tracking (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > HbbTV settings > HbbTV tracking > Off. Warning Remove HbbTV Cookies The USB Hard Drive is formatted exclusively for this TV, you cannot use the stored recordings on another TV or PC. Do not copy or change recording files on the USB Hard Drive with any PC application. This will corrupt your recordings. When you format another USB Hard Drive, the content on the former will be lost. A USB Hard Drive installed on your TV will need reformatting for use with a computer. (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > HbbTV settings > HbbTV cookies > On. Home or Shop Select the location of your TV To format a USB Hard Drive… (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Location. 1 - Connect the USB Hard Drive to one of the USB connections on the TV. Do not connect another USB device to the other USB ports when formatting. Select Shop, the picture style is switched back to Vivid, and can adjust shop settings. 52 Shop mode is for in-store promotion. 13.6 Adjust shop settings Clock, Region, and Language Settings (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Shop setup. Language (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Language. TV Guide The TV Guide receives information (data) from broadcasters or from the Internet. The TV can collect TV Guide information for the channels that are installed on the TV. Change the language of the TV menu and messages (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Language > Menu language. Select where the TV guide data receives from (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > TV guide. Set audio preference language (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Language > Primary audio, Secondary audio. Note: • In some regions and for some channels, TV guide information might not be available. • The TV cannot collect the TV guide information from channels viewed from a digital receiver or decoder. Digital TV channels can broadcast audio with several spoken languages for a programme. You can set a preferred primary and secondary audio language. If audio in one of these languages is available, the TV will switch to this audio. Channel Logos Switch off channel logos Set subtitle preference language (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Advanced > Channel logos. (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Language > Primary subtitle, Secondary subtitle. Digital channels can offer several subtitle languages for a programme. You can set a preferred primary and secondary subtitle language. If subtitles in one of these languages are available, the TV will show the subtitles you selected. Reset TV Settings and Reinstall TV Reset all settings value to original TV settings (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Factory settings. Set teletex preference language (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Language > Primary text, Secondary text. Redo full TV installation , and set TV status back to the first time you switch on (TV menu) > Settings > General settings > Reinstall TV. Some digital TV broadcasters have several Text languages available. Enter PIN code and select Yes, the TV will reinstall completely. All settings will be reset and installed channels will be replaced. Clock The installation can take a few minute (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock. Correct clock automatically 53 (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock > Auto clock mode. 13.8 Universal Access Settings • The standard setting for the TV clock is Automatic. The time information comes from the broadcasted UTC - Coordinated Universal Time information. • If the clock is not correct, you can set the TV clock to Country dependent. (TV menu) > Settings > Universal access. With Universal Access switched on, the TV is prepared for use for the deaf, hard of hearing, blind or partially sighted people. Correct clock manually Switch on universal access settings (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock > Auto clock mode > Manual. (TV menu) > Settings > Universal access > Universal access > On. (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock > Date, Time. Universal access for hearing impaired people Go to previous menu, and select Date and Time to adjust the value. Note: (TV menu) > Settings > Universal access > Hearing impaired > On. • If none of the automatic settings display the time correctly, you can set the time manually. • If you schedule recordings from the TV Guide, we recommend not to change the time and date manually. • Some digital TV channels broadcast special audio and subtitles adapted for the hard of hearing or deaf people. • Switched on, the TV automatically switches to the adapted audio and subtitles, if available. Set time zone or set a time offset for your region Universal access for blind or partially sighted people (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock > Time zone. (TV menu) > Settings > Universal access > Audio description > Audio description > On. Set the TV to switch to Standby automatically after a Digital TV channels can broadcast special audio commentary describing what is happening on screen. preset time (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Clock > Sleep timer. (TV menu) > Settings > Universal access > Audio description > Mixed volume, Audio effects, Speech. Remote Control Keyboard • Select Mixed volume, you can mix the volume of the normal audio with the audio commentary. Press the arrows (up) or (down) to adjust the value. • Set Audio effect to On for extra audio effects in the commentary audio, like stereo or fading sound. • Select Speech to set speech preference, Descriptive or Subtitles. (TV menu) > Settings > Region and language > Remote control keyboard To set the keyboard layout to Azerty. 13.7 13.9 Android Settings (TV menu) > Lock Settings Settings > Android settings. View the list of installed Apps, check out the free space to download more or uninstall an App. 54 Set Code and Change Code Lock for CAM Set new code or reset change code Set CAM PIN for recording (TV menu) > Settings > Child lock > Set code, Change code. (TV menu) > PIN. The child lock code is used to lock or unlock channels or programmes. Note: If you forgot your PIN code, you can override the current code use 8888 and enter a new code. Lock for Programme Set a minumum age to watch rated programmes (TV menu) > Settings > Child lock > Parental rating. Lock for App Set lock on App Gallery apps (TV menu) > lock. Settings > Child lock > App You can lock apps unsuited for children. You can lock 18+ rated apps from the App Gallery or set up a restricted profile in the Home menu. 18+ The 18+ app lock will ask for a PIN code when you try to start an 18+ rated app. This lock is only valid for 18+ rated apps from the Philips App Gallery. Restricted profile You can set up a restructed profile for the Home menu where only the apps you allow are available. You need to enter a PIN code to set up and switch on the restricted profile. Google Play Store - Maturity In the Google Play Store, you can hide apps according to users/buyers maturity. You need to enter a PIN code to select or change the level of maturity. The level of maturity will determine which apps are available for instalation. 55 Settings > Child lock > CAM 14 14.3 Videos, Photos and Music Most Popular Menu and Last Played Menu View most popular files or clear the list 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and select Most popular. 3 - Select one of the file and press OK to view files or press Clear all to clear the list. 14.1 From a Computer or NAS You can view your photos or play your music and videos from a computer or a NAS (Network Attached Storage) in your home network. View last played files 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and select Last played. 3 - Select one of the file and press OK to view files or press Clear all to clear the list. The TV and computer or NAS must be in the same home network. On your computer or NAS, you need to install Media Server Software. Your Media Server must be set to share your files with the TV. The TV shows your files and folders as they are organised by the Media Server or as they are structured on your computer or NAS. The TV does not support subtitles on video streams from a computer or NAS. 14.4 From a USB Connection If the Media Server supports searching for files, a search field is available. You can view your photos or play your music and videos from a connected USB flash drive or USB Hard Drive. To browse and play the files on your computer… 1 - Press SOURCES, select Network and press OK. 2 - Select SimplyShare Devices and press (right) to select the device you need. 3 - You can browse and play your files. 4 - To stop playing videos, photos and music, press EXIT. With the TV switched on, plug in a USB flash drive or a USB Hard Drive to one of the USB connections. The TV detects the device and will list your media files. If the list of files does not appear automatically… 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - You can browse your files in the folder structure you have organised on the drive. 4 - Press Play all to play all files in the USB folder or press Mark favourite to add the selected folder to favourite menu - Favourites. 5 - To stop playing videos, photos and music, press EXIT. 14.2 Favourites Menu Add a folder or a file to favourites menu 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and select a folder or a file. 3 - Press Mark favourite (green) to add the selected folder or file to the favourite menu. Warning If you try to pause or record a programme with a USB Hard Drive connected, the TV will ask you to format the USB Hard Drive. This formatting will delete all current files on the USB Hard Drive. View favourite files 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and select Favourites. 3 - You can view all favourite files in the list. 56 8 - Shuffle: play your files in a random order 9 - Repeat: plays all videos in this folder once or continuously 14.5 Play your Videos * If INFO key is available on your remote control Play Videos Open video folder 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Videos, you can press Mark favourite to add the video folder to favourite menu - Favourites. Video Options Browse video files... • List/Thumbnails – List or thumbnails views • Shuffle – Play your files in a random order • Repeat – Plays all videos in this folder once or continuously • Info – Show video information Play a video 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Videos and select one of video, you can press Play all to play all files in the folder or press Mark as favourite to add the selected video to favourite menu - Favourites. Playing video files... • Mark as favourites – Mark the video as favourites • Subtitle setting – Set subtitle font size, colour, position...etc • Info – Show video information 14.6 View your Photos Control bar To show or hide the control bar when a video is playing, press INFO*. View Photos Open photo folder 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Photos, you can press Mark favourite to add the photo folder to favourite menu - Favourites or press Sort for quickly finding a photo. View a photo 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Photos and select one of photos, you can press Slide show to play all files in the folder or press Mark favourite to add the selected photo to favourite menu - Favourites. 1 - Progress bar 2 - Playback control bar - : Jump to the previous video in a folder - : Jump to the next video in a folder - : Rewind - : Fast forward - : Pause the playback 3 - Mark as favourites 4 - Play all videos 5 - Subtitle: switch subtitles On, Off or On During Mute. 6 - Subtitle language: select a Subtitle Language 7 - Audio language: select an audio language Control bar 57 - Favourites. 4 - You can quickly find a music using classification - Genres, Artists, Albums, Tracks. Play music 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Music and select one of classifications to view music files. 4 - Select a music and you can press Play all to play all files in the folder or press Mark favourite to add the selected music to favourite menu - Favourites. 1 - Playback control bar - : Jump to the previous photo in a folder - : Jump to the next photo in a folder - : Pause the slideshow playback Control bar 2 - Mark as favourites 3 - Start a slideshow 4 - Rotate the photo 5 - Shuffle: play your files in a random order 6 - Repeat: plays all photos in this folder once or continuously 7 - Stop the music playing in the background 8 - Set the speed of the slide show Photo Options 1 - Progress bar 2 - Playback control bar - : Jump to the previous music in a folder - : Jump to the next music in a folder - : Rewind - : Fast forward - : Pause the playback Browse photo files... • List/Thumbnails – List or thumbnails views • Shuffle – Play your files in a random order • Repeat – Play the slide show once or continuously • Slide Show Speed – Set the speed of the slide show 3 - Mark as favourites 4 - Play all music 5 - Shuffle: play your files in a random order 6 - Repeat: plays all music in this folder once or continuously Playing photo files... • Mark as favourites – Mark the photo as favourites • Info – Show video information 14.7 Music Options Play your Music Browse music files... Play Music • Shuffle – Play your files in a random order. Open photo folder 1 - Press SOURCES, select USB and press OK. 2 - Select USB Devices and press (right) to select the USB device you need. 3 - Select Music, you can press Mark favourite to add the music folder to favourite menu • Repeat – Plays all songs in this folder once or continuously. Playing music files... • Mark as favourites – Mark the music as favourites 58 • Info – Show music information 59 Internet or vice versa. The TV might have switched to From the Internet automatically. To make the recordings available in the list of recordings, switch to the setting that was selected when the recordings were made. 15 TV Guide 15.1 What You Need 15.3 With the TV Guide you can view a list of the current and scheduled TV programmes of your channels. Depending on where the TV guide information (data) is coming from, analogue and digital channels or only digital channels are shown. Not all channels offer TV Guide information. Using the TV Guide Open the TV Guide To open the TV Guide, press TV GUIDE. The TV Guide shows the channels of the selected tuner. The TV can collect TV Guide information for the channels that are installed on the TV. The TV cannot collect the TV Guide information for channels viewed from a digital receiver or decoder. Press TV GUIDE again to close. The first time you open the TV Guide, the TV scans all TV channels for programme information. This may take several minutes. TV Guide data is stored on TV. 15.2 TV Guide Data Tune to a Programme The TV Guide receives information (data) from broadcasters or from the Internet. In some regions and for some channels, TV Guide information might not be available. The TV can collect TV Guide information for the channels that are installed on the TV. The TV cannot collect the TV Guide information from channels viewed from a digital receiver or decoder. From the TV Guide, you can tune to a current programme. The TV comes with the information set to From the Broadcaster. 1 - Press INFO. 2 - Press BACK to close. To switch to the programme (channel), select the programme and press OK. View programme details To call up the details of the selected programme… If TV Guide information comes from the Internet, the TV Guide can also list analogue channels next to the digital channels. The TV Guide menu also shows a small screen with the current channel. Change Day From the Internet The TV Guide can show the scheduled programmes for the upcoming days (maximum up to 8 days). If the TV is connected to the Internet, you can set the TV to receive the TV Guide information from the Internet. Press the colour key Day and select the day you need. To set the TV Guide information… Set a Reminder 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select General Settings and press (right) to enter the menu. 3 - Select Advanced > TV Guide > From the Internet and press OK. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. You can set a reminder for a programme. A message will alert you at the start of the programme. You can tune to this channel immediately. In the TV Guide a programme with a reminder is marked with a (clock). Missing recordings To set a reminder… When some recordings seem to have disappeared from the list of recordings, the TV Guide info (data) might have changed. Recordings made with the setting From the Broadcaster become invisible in the list if you switch the setting to From the 1 - Press TV GUIDE and select an upcoming programme. 2 - Press the colour key Set Reminder and press OK. 3 - Press BACK to close the menu. 60 2 - Press the colour key Record . 3 - Press BACK to close the menu. To clear a reminder… 1 - Press TV GUIDE and select a programme with the reminder. 2 - Press the colour key Clear Reminder and press OK. 3 - Press BACK to close the menu. To cancel a recording… 1 - Press TV GUIDE and select the programme set for recording. 2 - Press the colour key Clear Recording . 3 - Press BACK to close the menu. * See chapter Recording and Pause TV for more information. Search by Genre If the information is available, you can look up scheduled programmes by genre like movies, sports, etc. To search for programmes by genre… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press OPTIONS. 3 - Select Search by Genre and press OK. 4 - Select the genre you want and press OK. A list with the found programmes appears. 5 - You can set reminders or schedule a recording on a selected programme. 6 - Press BACK to close the menu. For more information on Recording, press the colour key Keywords and look up Recording. * Not available when selecting DVB-S channel List of Reminders You can view a list of the reminders you have set. List of Reminders To open the list of reminders… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - At the top of the screen, select Scheduled and press OK. 4 - In the list of scheduled recordings and reminders, select the tab Reminders and press OK to view the reminders only. 5 - Press the colour key Remove to remove the selected reminder. Press the colour key Record to record the selected programme. 6 - Press BACK to close the menu. Set a Recording You can set a recording in the TV Guide*. To see the recording list, press Recordings , a programme set to be recorded is marked with a (red dot) on the front of the programme name. To record a programme… 1 - Press TV GUIDE and select a future or ongoing programme. 61 16 Schedule a Recording Recording and Pause TV You can schedule a recording of an upcoming programme for today or a few days from today (maximum of 8 days away). The TV will use the data from the TV Guide to start and end the recording. To record a programme… 16.1 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - On the TV Guide, select the channel and programme you wish to record. Press (right) or (left) to scroll through the programmes of a channel. Use the colour key Day to select the day you need. 3 - With the programme highlighted, press the colour key Record . The programme is scheduled for recording. A warning will show automatically when overlapping recordings are scheduled. If you plan to record a programme in your absence, remember to leave the TV switched to Standby and the USB Hard Drive switched on. 4 - The TV adds some time margin at the end of the programme. You can adjust this margin with Auto End Margin. 5 - Press BACK to close the menu. Recording What You Need You can record a digital TV broadcast and watch it later. To record a TV programme you need… • a connected USB Hard Drive formatted on this TV • digital TV channels installed on this TV • to receive channel information for the on screen TV Guide • a reliable TV clock setting. If you reset the TV clock manually, recordings may fail. You cannot record when you are using Pause TV. In terms enforcement of copyright legislation, some DVB providers can apply different restriction by means of DRM (Digital Right Management) technology. In case of broadcasting protected channels, recording, record validity or number of views may be restricted. Recording may be completely prohibited. In case of trying to record a protected broadcasting or play back an expired recording, an error message can appear. List of Recordings You can view and manage your recordings in the list of recordings. Next to the list of recordings, there is a separate list for scheduled recordings and reminders. To open the list or recordings… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - In the list of recordings, select the tabs New, Watched or Expired and press OK to filter your view. 4 - With a recording selected in the list, you can remove the recording with the colour key Remove or stop an ongoing recording with the colour key Stop Recording . You can rename a recording with the colour key Rename . 5 - Press BACK to close the menu. For more information on installing a USB Hard Drive, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up USB Hard Drive, installation. Record a Programme Record Now To record the programme you are watching right now, press (Record) on the remote control. The recording will start immediately. Broadcasters can limit the number of days a recording can be viewed. When this period expires, the recording will be marked as expired. A recording in the list can show the number of days before it expires. To stop the recording, press (Stop). When TV Guide data is available, the programme you are watching will be recorded from the moment you pressed the recording key until the programme ends. If no TV Guide data is available, the recording will only last 30 minutes. You can adjust the end time of the recording in the list of Recordings. When a scheduled recording was prevented by the broadcaster or when the broadcast was interrupted, a recording is marked as Failed. Recording Conflicts When two scheduled recordings are overlapping in time, there is a recording conflict. To solve a recording conflict, you can adjust the start and end time of one 62 or both scheduled recordings. recordings and reminders. To adjust the start or end time of a scheduled recording… Watch a Recording 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - At the top of the screen, select Scheduled and press OK. 4 - In the list of scheduled recordings and reminders, select the tab Recordings and press OK to view the scheduled recordings only. 5 - Select the scheduled recording that conflicts with another scheduled recording and press the colour key Adjust Time . 6 - Select the start or end time and change the time with the (up) or (down) keys. Select Apply and press OK. 7 - Press BACK to close the menu. To watch a recording… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - In the list of recordings, select the recording you need and press OK to start watching. 4 - You can use the keys (pause), (play), (rewind), (fast forward) or (stop). 5 - To switch back to watch TV, press EXIT. 16.2 Pause TV Auto End Margin What You Need You can set the time margin that the TV will add automatically at the end of each scheduled recording. You can pause a digital TV broadcast and resume watching it a bit later. To set the automatic end time margin… To pause a TV programme you need… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - Press OPTIONS and select Auto End Margin and press OK. 4 - Press (up) or (down) and press OK to set the time margin added to a recording automatically. You can add up to 45 minutes to a recording. 5 - Press BACK to close the menu. • a connected USB Hard Drive formatted on this TV • digital TV channels installed on this TV • to receive channel information for the on screen TV Guide With the USB Hard Drive connected and formatted, the TV continuously stores the TV broadcast you are watching. When you switch to another channel, the broadcast of the former channel is cleared. Also when you switch the TV to standby the broadcast is cleared. Manual Recording You cannot use Pause TV when you are recording. You can schedule a recording that is not linked to a TV programme. You set the tuner type, channel and the start and end time yourself. For more information, in Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up USB Hard Drive, installation. To schedule a recording manually… 1 - Press TV GUIDE. 2 - Press the colour key Recordings . 3 - At the top of the screen, select Scheduled and press OK. 4 - Press OPTIONS, select Schedule and press OK. 5 - Select the tuner from where you want to record and press OK. 6 - Select the channel to record from and press OK. 7 - Select the day of the recording and press OK. 8 - Set the start and end time of the recording. Select a button and use the (up) or (down) keys to set the hours and minutes. 9 - Select Record and press OK to schedule the manual recording. Pause a Programme To pause and resume a broadcast… • To pause a broadcast, press (Pause). A progress bar at the bottom of the screen appears briefly. • To call up the progress bar, press (Pause) again. • To resume watching, press (Play). With the progress bar on screen, press (Rewind) or press (Forward) to select from where you want to start viewing the paused broadcast. Press these keys repeatedly to change speed. You can pause a broadcast for a maximum time span of 90 minutes. To switch back to the live TV broadcast, The recording will appear in the list of scheduled 63 press (Stop). Replay Since the TV stores the broadcast you are watching, you can mostly replay the broadcast for a few seconds. To replay a current broadcast… 1 - Press (Pause) 2 - Press (Rewind). You can press repeatedly to select from where you want to start viewing the paused broadcast. Press these keys repeatedly to change speed. At one point you will reach the start of the broadcast storage or the maximum time span. 3 - Press (Play) to watch the broadcast again. 4 - Press (Stop) to watch the broadcast live. 64 17 Cast to Your TV Smartphones and Tablets To cast an app to the TV screen… Philips TV Remote App 1 - On your smartphone or tablet, open an app that supports Google Cast. 2 - Tab the Google Cast icon. 3 - Select the TV you would like to cast to. 4 - Press play on your smartphone or tablet. What you selected should start playing on TV. The new Philips TV Remote App on your smartphone or tablet is your new TV buddy. 17.3 17.1 With the TV Remote App, you master your media around you. Send photos, music or videos to your big TV screen or watch any of your TV channels live on your tablet or phone. Look up what you want to watch on the TV Guide and watch it on your phone or TV. With the TV Remote App you can use your phone as a remote control. AirPlay To add the AirPlay functionality to your Android TV, you can download and install one of the several Android apps that do just that. You can find several of these apps in the Google Play Store. Download the Philips TV Remote App from your favourite app store today. 17.4 MHL The Philips TV Remote App is available for iOS and Android and is free of charge. This TV is MHL™ compliant. If your mobile device is also MHL compliant, you can connect your mobile device with a MHL cable to the TV. With the MHL cable connected you can share what's on your mobile device on the TV screen. Your mobile device charges its battery at the same time. The MHL connection is ideal for watching movies or playing games from your mobile device on TV for a longer time. 17.2 Google Cast What You Need If an app on your mobile device has Google Cast, you can cast your app on this TV. On the mobile app, look for the Google Cast icon. You can use your mobile device to control what's on TV. Google Cast works on Android and iOS. Charging With the MHL cable connected, your device will charge while the TV is switched on (not in standby). Your mobile device must be connected to the same Wi-Fi home network as your TV. MHL Cable You need a passive MHL cable (HDMI to Micro USB) to connect your mobile device to the TV. You might need an extra adapter to connect to your mobile device. To connect the MHL cable to the TV use the HDMI 1 MHL connection. Apps with Google Cast New Google Cast apps come available every day. You can already try it with YouTube, Chrome, Netflix, Photowall … or Big Web Quiz for Chromecast. See also google.com/cast Some Google Play products and features aren't available in all countries. Find more information on support.google.com/androidtv MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link and the MHL Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of the MHL, LLC. 65 Dependent. • you must accept the Terms of Use (You might have accepted already when you connected to the Internet.). 18 Top Picks The icon will only appear at the top of the screen when Now on TV is available. 18.1 About Top Picks The TV does not store former recommendations. With Top Picks your TV recommends… • current TV programmes in Now on TV • online TV services (Catch Up TV) in TV on Demand • the latest rental videos in Video on Demand • online TV services (Catch Up TV) from Freeview in Freeview Play Using Now on TV To open Now on TV… 1 - Press TOP PICKS to open the Top Picks menu. 2 - Select Now on TV at the top of the screen and press OK. 3 - Press BACK to close. To enjoy Top Picks, connect your TV to the Internet. Make sure you agree to the Terms of Use. The Top Picks information and services are only available in selected countries. When you open Now on TV, the TV may need a few seconds to refresh the page information. Terms of Use To allow the TV to make these recommendations, you must agree to the Terms of Use. To get personalised recommendations based on your viewing habits, make sure you checked the box for Personalized Recommendations Service Opt-In. In Now on TV you can… • select and press OK on a programme icon to tune to the ongoing programme. • select and press OK on a scheduled programme icon to tune to the channel already. To open the Terms of Use… You can use the colour keys on the remote control to start, stop or clear a scheduled recording. You can also set or remove a reminder that warns you when a programme starts. 1 - Press TOP PICKS. 2 - Press OPTIONS, select Terms of Use and press OK. 3 - Select Privacy Settings and press OK. 4 - Select Personalized Recommendations Service Opt-In and press OK to check the box. Press OK again to uncheck. 5 - Press BACK to close the menu. To leave Now on TV without tuning to another channel, press BACK. 18.3 TV on Demand 18.2 Now on TV About TV on Demand About Now on TV With TV on Demand , you can watch TV programmes you missed or watch your favourite programmes whenever it suits you best. This service is also called Catch Up TV, Replay TV or Online TV. Programmes available on TV on Demand are free to watch. With Now on TV , the TV recommends the 10 most popular programmes to watch at this moment. The TV recommends programmes on TV now or starting within 15 minutes. The recommended programmes are selected from the channels you installed. The selection is made from channels of your country. Also, you can let Now on TV do some personalised recommendations for you, based on programmes you watch regularly. You can let TV on Demand do some personalised recommendations of programmes, based on the TV installation and the programmes you watch regularly. The icon will only appear at the top of the screen when TV on Demand is available. To make the Now on TV information available… • the Now on TV information must be available in your country. • the TV must have channels installed. • the TV must be connected to the Internet. • the TV Clock must be set to Automatic or Country 66 Using TV on Demand You can select a specific video store if more than one is available. To open TV on Demand… To rent a movie… 1 - Press TOP PICKS to open the Top Picks menu. 2 - Select TV on Demand at the top of the screen and press OK. 3 - Press (down) to open the page full screen. 4 - You can select a specific broadcaster if more than one is available. 5 - Select a programme icon and press OK to start watching. 6 - Press BACK to close. 1 - Navigate the highlight on a movie poster. Limited info will show after some seconds. 2 - Press OK to open the movie page of the video store for a synopsis of the movie. 3 - Confirm your order. 4 - Make the payment on TV. 5 - Start watching. You can use the (Play) and (Pause) keys. When you open TV on Demand, the TV may need a few seconds to refresh the page information. Once a programme started, you can use the (Play) and (Pause) keys. 18.4 Video on Demand About Video on Demand With Video on Demand , you can rent movies from an online rental video store. You can let Video on Demand do some personalised recommendations of movies, based on your country, the TV installation and the programmes you watch regularly. The icon will only appear at the top of the screen when Video on Demand is available. Payment When you rent or buy a movie, you can pay the video store securely with your credit card. Most video stores ask you to create a login account the first time you rent a movie. Internet Traffic Streaming a lot of videos may cause you to exceed your monthly Internet traffic limit. Using Video on Demand To open Video on Demand… 1 - Press TOP PICKS to open the Top Picks menu. 2 - Select Video on Demand at the top of the screen and press OK. 3 - Use the navigation keys to select a movie poster. 4 - Press BACK to close. When you open Video on Demand, the TV may need a few seconds to refresh the page information. 67 19 Home Menu 19.1 Open the Home Menu To open the Home menu and open an item… 1 - Press HOME. 2 - Select an item and press OK to open or start it. 3 - Press BACK to close the Home menu without starting anything. 19.2 Restricted Profile You can restrict the use of certain apps by switching the TV to a restricted profile. This restricted profile will only allow the use of apps which you have selected. You can only switch out of this profile with a PIN code. With the TV switched to a restricted profile you cannot… • Find or open apps which are marked as Not allowed • Access the Google Play Store • Purchase through Google Play Movies & TV, nor Google Play Games • Use third-party apps that don't use the Google signin With the TV switched to a restricted profile you can… • Watch content already rented or purchased from Google Play Movies & TV • Play games already purchased and installed from Google Play Games • Access the following settings: Wi-Fi network, Speech and Accessibility • Add Bluetooth accessories The Google Account on TV will stay logged in. Using a restricted profile doesn't change the Google Account. 68 20 Netflix If you have a Netflix membership subscription, you can enjoy Netflix on this TV. Your TV must be connected to the Internet. In your region, Netflix might only come available with future software updates. To open Netflix, press to open the Netflix App. You can open Netflix immediately from a TV in standby. www.netflix.com 69 21 identification file is written on the USB flash drive. Software Download the software 1 - Insert the USB flash drive into your computer. 2 - On the USB flash drive, locate the file update.htm and double click it. 3 - Click Send ID. 4 - If new software is available, download the .zip file. 5 - After the download, unzip the file and copy the file autorun.upg onto the USB flash drive. Do not place this file in a folder. 21.1 Update Software Update from Internet If the TV is connected to the Internet, you may receive a message to update the TV software. You need a high-speed (broadband) Internet connection. If you receive this message, we recommend you to carry out the update. Update the TV software 1 - Insert the USB flash drive into the TV again. The update starts automatically. 2 - A software update can take several minutes. Do not press the key on the TV or remote control. Do not remove the USB flash drive. 3 - When the update is done, the TV will return to the channel you were watching. With the message on screen, select Update and follow the instructions on-screen. You can also look for a software update yourself. During the software update, there is no picture and the TV will switch off and on again. This might happen several times. The update can take a few minutes. Wait until the TV picture comes back up. Do not press the power switch on the TV or on the remote control during the software update. If a power cut occurs during the update, never remove the USB flash drive from the TV. When the power returns, the update will continue. To prevent an accidental update of the TV software, delete the autorun.upg file from the USB flash drive. To look for a software update yourself… 21.2 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software > Search for Updates and press OK. 3 - Select Internet and press OK. 4 - The TV will look for an update on the Internet. 5 - If an update is available, you can update the software right away. 6 - A software update can take several minutes. Do not press the key on the TV or remote control. 7 - When the update is done, the TV will return to the channel you were watching. Software Version To view the current TV software version… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software > Current Software Info and press OK. 3 - The version, release notes and creation date are shown. Also, the Netflix ESN Number is shown if available. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. Update from USB 21.3 It might be necessary to update the TV software. Automatic Software Update You need a computer with an high-speed Internet connection and a USB flash drive to upload the software on the TV. Use a USB flash drive with at least 2Gb free space. Make sure that write protection is switched off. To switch on Automatic software update to update your TV software automatically. Leave the TV in standby. 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software > Automatic Software Update and press OK. 3 - Follow the on-screen instruction. 4 - Press (left) repeatedly if necessary, to close the menu. To update the TV software… 1 - Press , select All Settings and press OK. 2 - Select Update Software > Search for Updates and press OK. 3 - Select USB and press OK. Identify the TV 1 - Insert the USB flash drive into one of the USB connections of the TV. 2 - Select Write to USB and press OK. An 70 ( http://source.android.com/source/licenses.html ). This includes all external sources used by official Android AOSP. 21.4 Open Source Software This television contains open source software. TP Vision Europe B.V. hereby offers to deliver, upon request, a copy of the complete corresponding source code for the copyrighted open source software packages used in this product for which such offer is requested by the respective licences. linux kernel (3.10.79) This tv contains the Linux Kernel. The original download site for this software is : http://www.kernel.org/ . This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license, which can be found below. Additionally, following exception applies: "NOTE! This copyright does *not* cover user programs that use kernel services by normal system calls - this is merely considered normal use of the kernel, and does *not* fall under the heading of "derived work". Also note that the GPL below is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, but the instance of code that it refers to (the linux kernel) is copyrighted by me and others who actually wrote it. Also note that the only valid version of the GPL as far as the kernel is concerned is _this_ particular version of the license (ie v2, not v2.2 or v3.x or whatever), unless explicitly otherwise stated. Linus Torvalds" This offer is valid up to three years after product purchase to anyone in receipt of this information. To obtain the source code, please write in English to . .. open.source@tpvision.com 21.5 Open Source License About Open Source License README for the source code of the parts of TP Vision Netherlands B.V. TV software that fall under open source licenses. libcurl (7.50.1) This is a document describing the distribution of the source code used on the TP Vision Netherlands B.V. TV, which fall either under the GNU General Public License (the GPL), or the GNU Lesser General Public License (the LGPL), or any other open source license. Instructions to obtain copies of this software can be found in the Directions For Use. libcurl is a free and easy-to-use client-side URL transfer library, supporting DICT, FILE, FTP, FTPS, Gopher, HTTP, HTTPS, IMAP, IMAPS, LDAP, LDAPS, POP3, POP3S, RTMP, RTSP, SCP, SFTP, SMTP, SMTPS, Telnet and TFTP. libcurl supports SSL certificates, HTTP POST, HTTP PUT, FTP uploading, HTTP form based upload, proxies, cookies, user+password authentication (Basic, Digest, NTLM, Negotiate, Kerberos), file transfer resume, http proxy tunneling and more! The original download site for this software is : http://curl.haxx.se/libcurl/ COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE Copyright (c) 1996 - 2010, Daniel Stenberg, daniel@haxx.se. All rights reserved. Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS ORIMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. INNO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OROTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USEOR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, TP Vision Netherlands B.V. MAKES NO WARRANTIES WHATSOEVER, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, REGARDING THIS SOFTWARE. TP Vision Netherlands B.V. offers no support for this software. The preceding does not affect your warranties and statutory rights regarding any TP Vision Netherlands B.V. product(s) you purchased. It only applies to this source code made available to you. Open Source Android (7.1.1) This tv contains the Android Nougat Software. Android is a Linux-based operating system designed primarily for touchscreen mobile devices such as smartphones and tablet computers. This software will also be reused in TPVision Android based TV's. The original download site for this software is : https://android.googlesource.com/. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache license version 2, which can be found below. Android APACHE License Version 2 71 use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. platform-independent library that contains C functions for handling PNG images. It supports almost all of PNG's features, is extensible. The original download site for this software is : https://github.com/julienr/libpng-androidlibpng license libfreetypeex (2.4.2) FreeType is a software development library, available in source and binary forms, used to render text on to bitmaps and provides support for other font-related operations. The original download site for this software is : https://github.com/julienr/libfreetype-android Freetype License dvbsnoop (1.2) dvbsnoop is a DVB / MPEG stream analyzer program. For generating CRC32 values required for composing PAT, PMT, EIT sections The original download site for this software is : https://github.com/a4tunado/dvbsn oop/blob/master/src/misc/crc32.cGPL v2 http://dvbsnoop.sourceforge.net/dvbsnoop.html libjpegex (8a) This package contains C software to implement JPEG image encoding, decoding, and transcoding. This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.----------------------The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation, either express or implied, with respect to this software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or fitness for a particular purpose. This software is provided "AS IS", and you, its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality and accuracy. This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G. Lane. All Rights Reserved except as specified below. Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software (or portions thereof) for any purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions:(1) If any part of the source code for this software is distributed, then this README file must be included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation.(2) If only executable code is distributed, then the accompanying documentation must state that "this software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group".(3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts full responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the authors accept NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind. These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code, not just to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you ought to acknowledge us. Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author's name or company name in advertising or publicity relating to this software or products derived from it. This software may be referred to only as "the Independent JPEG Group's software". We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of commercial products, provided that all warranty or liability claims are assumed by the product vendor. gSoap (2.7.15) The gSOAP toolkit is an open source C and C++ software development toolkit for SOAP/XML Web services and generic (non-SOAP) C/C++ XML data bindings. Part of the software embedded in this product is gSOAP software. Portions created by gSOAP are Copyright 2001-2009 Robert A. van Engelen, Genivia inc. All Rights Reserved. THE SOFTWARE IN THIS PRODUCT WAS IN PART PROVIDED BY GENIVIA INC AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. restlet (2.3.0) Restlet is a lightweight, comprehensive, open source REST framework for the Java platform. Restlet is suitable for both server and client Web applications. It supports major Internet transport, data format, and service description standards like HTTP and HTTPS, SMTP, XML, JSON, Atom, and WADL. The original download site for this software is : http://restlet.org This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache License version 2. libpngex (1.4.1) libpng is the official Portable Network Graphics (PNG) reference library (originally called pnglib). It is a FaceBook SDK (3.0.1) 72 This TV contains Facebook SDK. The Facebook SDK for Android is the easiest way to integrate your Android app with Facebook's platform. The SDK provides support for Login with Facebook authentication, reading and writing to Facebook APIs and support for UI elements such as pickers and dialogs. The original download site for this software is : https://developer.facebook.com/docs/android This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache License version 2. forwarder and DHCP server. The original download site for this software is : https://android.googlesource.com/platform/external/ dnmasq This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license, which can be found below. TomCrypt (1.1) iwedia stack is using tomcrypt for sw decryption. The original download site for this software is : http://manpages.ubuntu.com/manpages/saucy/man 3/libtomcrypt.3.html. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the WTFPL. ffmpeg (2.1.3) This TV uses FFmpeg. FFmpeg is a complete, crossplatform solution to record, convert and stream audio and video. The original download site for this software is : http://ffmpeg.org This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license, which can be found below. u-boot (2011-12) U-boot is a boot loader for embedded boards based on ARM, MIPS and other processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application code. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2 license, which can be found below. gson (2.3) This TV uses gson. Gson is a Java library that can be used to convert Java Objects into their JSON representation. It can also be used to convert a JSON string to an equivalent Java object. Gson can work with arbitrary Java objects including pre-existing objects that you do not have source-code of. The original download site for this software is : https://code.google.com/p/google-gson/ . This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache License 2.0 AsyncHttpclient (1.4.9) The original download site for this software is : http://loopj.com/android-async-http/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 This software includes an implementation of the AES Cipher, licensed by Brian Gladman. The original download site for this software is : http://www.gladman.me.uk/ This piece of software is licensed by Brian Gladman. httpclient-4.4.1.1 (4.4.1.1) This is needed to import cz.msebera.android.httpclient used by AssyncHttpClientThe original download site for this software is : http://mvnrepository.com/artifact/cz.msebera.androi d/httpclient/4.4.1.1 This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 libUpNp (1.2.1) The original download site for this software is : http://upnp.sourceforge.net/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. live555 (0.82) Jackson Parser (2.x) Live555 provides RTP/RTCP/RTSP client.The original download site for this software is : http://www.live555.com This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the LGPL v2.1 license, which can be found below. Ipepg client uses Jackson Parser for string manipulation. The original download site for this software is : https://github.com/FasterXML/jackson-core This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 dnsmasq Dnsmasq is a lightweight, easy to configure DNS audio a2dp (2.x) 73 Bluetooth stack. The original download site for this software is : https://android.googlesource.com/platform/system/ bt This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 libmtp (1.0.1) libmtp The original download site for this software is : http://libmtp.sourceforge.net/ . This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the LGPL V2. libexif (0.6.21) libmdnssd (320.10.80) Exif JPEG header manipulation tool. The original download site for this software is : http://libexif.sourceforge.net/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 MDNS Responder. The mDNSResponder project is a component of Bonjour, 5Apple's ease-of-use IP networking initiative. The original download site for this software is : http://www.opensource.apple.com/tarballs/mDNSRe sponder/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache license version 2 libexpat (2.1.0) Expat XML Parser. The original download site for this software is : http://www.libexpat.org/Expat is free software. You may copy, distribute, and modify it under the terms of the License contained in the file COPYING distributed with this package. This license is the same as the MIT/X Consortium license. libnfc_ndef ( ) The original download site for this software is : No info. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Apache license version 2 libFFTEm ( ) neven face recognition library. The original download site for this software is : No info. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the APACHE LICENSE 2.0 libskia ( ) skia 2D graphics library Skia is a complete 2D graphic library for drawing Text, Geometries, and Images. The original download site for this software is : http://code.google.com/p/skia/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. libicui18n (49.1.1) International Components for unicode. The original download site for this software is : http://icu-project.org This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. libsonivox ( ) The original download site for this software is : No info. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2. libiprouteutil (3.4.0) iproute2 TCP/IP networking and traffic control. The original download site for this software is : http://www.linuxfoundation.org/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPL v2. which can be found below libsqlite (3.9.2) SQLite database. The original download site for this software is : http://www.sqlite.org This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2. libjpeg (3.4.0) libjpeg-turbo is a JPEG image codec that uses SIMD instructions (MMX, SSE2, NEON) to accelerate baseline JPEG compression and decompression on x86, x86-64, and ARM systems. The original download site for this software is : http://www.ijg.org/libjpeg-turbo is covered by three compatible BSD-style open source licenses. Refer to LICENSE.txt for a roll-up of license terms. libttspico ( ) The original download site for this software is : No info. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2. 74 libtinyalsa ( ) (7b8b9c17db93ea5287575b437c77fb36eeb81b31) tinyalsa: a small library to interface with ALSA in the Linux kernel. The original download site for this software is : No info. This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. OpenMAX AL is an application-level multimedia playback and recording API for mobile embedded devicesThe original download site for this software is : https://www.khronos.org/openmax/ License free wpa_supplicant (0.8) libOpenSLES (1.0) Library used by legacy HAL to talk to wpa_supplicant daemon. The original download site for this software is : http://hostap.epitest.fi/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPLv2. Khronos OpenSL Sound API spec. The original download site for this software is : https://www.khronos.org/opensles/ License free libEGL libGLESv1_CM (3.1) Khronos OpenGL Graphics API spec. The original download site for this software is : https://www.opengl.org/ License free libz (1.2.8) zlib compression library. The original download site for this software is : http://zlib.net This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. libffmpeg_av (2.1) FFmpeg media player. The original download site for this software is : https://ffmpeg.org/ This piece of software is licensed under LGPL v2.1 iptables (1.4.20) iptables is a user space application program that allows a system administrator to configure the tables provided by the Linux kernel firewall (implemented as different Netfilter modules) and the chains and rules it stores. Different kernel modules and programs are currently used for different protocols; iptables applies to IPv4The original download site for this software is : https://android.googlesource.com/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the GPLv2. libcurlmheg (7.21.6) curl for MHEG. The original download site for this software is : https://ffmpeg.org/ Curl and libcurl are licensed under a MIT/X derivate license. Please look at https://curl.haxx.se/docs/copyright.html boringssl (af0e32cb84f0c9cc65b9233a3414d2562642b342) ssl for MHEG, Taken from android M. The original download site for this software is : https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl/ Licensed under BSD, please find in /android/nbase/external/boringssl/NOTICE toolbox (1.2.8) The 'toolbox' command in Android is a multi-function program. It encapsulates the functionality of many common Linux commands (and some special Android ones) into a single binary. This makes it more compact than having all those other commands installed individually. The original download site for this software is : https://android.googlesource.com/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the Android APACHE License Version 2. libpng (1.6.22beta) libpng is the official Portable Network Graphics (PNG) reference library (originally called pnglib). It is a platform-independent library that contains C functions for handling PNG images. It supports almost all of PNG's features, is extensible. The original download site for this software is : https://github.com/julienr/libpng-android This code is released under the libpng license. libssl (7b8b9c17db93ea5287575b437c77fb36eeb81b31) BoringSSL The original download site for this software is : https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl/ This piece of software is made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD. Hue SDK (1.8.1) TV ambihue app uses Philips SDK to find the hue bridge name. The original download site for this software is : libOpenMAXAL 75 https://developers.meethue.com/documentation/jav a-multi-platform-and-android-sdk with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Opera Web Browser (SDK 4.8.0) THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE COMPUTER, INC. ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL APPLE COMPUTER, INC. OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This TV contains Opera Browser Software. Third-party licenses WebKit name License WebKit URL: http://webkit.org/ (WebKit doesn't distribute an explicit license. This LICENSE is derived from license text in the source.) Copyright (c) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Alexander Kellett, Alexey Proskuryakov, Alex Mathews, Allan Sandfeld Jensen, Alp Toker, Anders Carlsson, Andrew Wellington, Antti Koivisto, Apple Inc., Arthur Langereis, Baron Schwartz, Bjoern Graf, Brent Fulgham, Cameron Zwarich, Charles Samuels, Christian Dywan, Collabora Ltd., Cyrus Patel, Daniel Molkentin, Dave Maclachlan, David Smith, Dawit Alemayehu, Dirk Mueller, Dirk Schulze, Don Gibson, Enrico Ros, Eric Seidel, Frederik Holljen, Frerich Raabe, Friedmann Kleint, George Staikos, Google Inc., Graham Dennis, Harri Porten, Henry Mason, Hiroyuki Ikezoe, Holger Hans Peter Freyther, IBM, James G. Speth, Jan Alonzo, Jean-Loup Gailly, John Reis, Jonas Witt, Jon Shier, Jonas Witt, Julien Chaffraix, Justin Haygood, Kevin Ollivier, Kevin Watters, Kimmo Kinnunen, Kouhei Sutou, Krzysztof Kowalczyk, Lars Knoll, Luca Bruno, Maks Orlovich, Malte Starostik, Mark Adler, Martin Jones, Marvin Decker, Matt Lilek, Michael Emmel, Mitz Pettel, mozilla.org, Netscape Communications Corporation, Nicholas Shanks, Nikolas Zimmermann, Nokia, Oliver Hunt, Opened Hand, Paul Johnston, Peter Kelly, Pioneer Research Center USA, Rich Moore, Rob Buis, Robin Dunn, Ronald Tschalär, Samuel Weinig, Simon Hausmann, Staikos Computing Services Inc., Stefan Schimanski, Symantec Corporation, The Dojo Foundation, The Karbon Developers, Thomas Boyer, Tim Copperfield, Tobias Anton, Torben Weis, Trolltech, University of Cambridge, Vaclav Slavik, Waldo Bastian, Xan Lopez, Zack Rusin GNU LIBRARY GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 2, June 1991 Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. Preamble The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This license, the Library General Public License, applies to some specially designated Free Software Foundation software, and to any other libraries whose authors decide to use it. You can use it for your libraries, too. When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things. The terms and conditions vary from file to file, but are one of: Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions *OR* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, 76 translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library, or if you modify it. would deprive the users of those programs of all benefit from the free status of the libraries themselves. This Library General Public License is intended to permit developers of non-free programs to use free libraries, while preserving your freedom as a user of such programs to change the free libraries that are incorporated in them. (We have not seen how to achieve this as regards changes in header files, but we have achieved it as regards changes in the actual functions of the Library.) The hope is that this will lead to faster development of free libraries. For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. If you link a program with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients so that they can relink them with the library, after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a"work based on the library" and a "work that uses the library". The former contains code derived from the library, while the latter only works together with the library. Our method of protecting your rights has two steps: (1) copyright the library, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library. Also, for each distributor's protection, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free library. If the library is modified by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original version, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors' reputations. Note that it is possible for a library to be covered by the ordinary General Public License rather than by this special one. GNU LIBRARY GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that companies distributing free software will individually obtain patent licenses, thus in effect transforming the program into proprietary software. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of this Library General Public License (also called "this License"). Each licensee is addressed as "you". Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License, which was designed for utility programs. This license, the GNU Library General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries. This license is quite different from the ordinary one; be sure to read it in full, and don't assume that anything in it is the same as in the ordinary license. A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and data) to form executables. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these terms. A "work based on the Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) The reason we have a separate public license for some libraries is that they blur the distinction we usually make between modifying or adding to a program and simply using it. Linking a program with a library, without changing the library, is in some sense simply using the library, and is analogous to running a utility program or application program. However, in a textual and legal sense, the linked executable is a combined work, a derivative of the original library, and the ordinary General Public License treats it as such. "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associate interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the library. Because of this blurred distinction, using the ordinary General Public License for libraries did not effectively promote software sharing, because most developers did not use the libraries. We concluded that weaker conditions might promote sharing better. Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program However, unrestricted linking of non-free programs 77 using the Library is not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that uses the Library does. sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library. 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License. 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these notices. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) The modified work must itself be a software library. Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy. b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a program that is not a library. c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License. 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange. d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful. If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code. (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is entirely welldefined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the squareroot function must still compute square roots.) 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this License. These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative 78 of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the library". The executable is therefore covered by this License. b) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more than the cost of performing this distribution. Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables. c) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the same place. When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. d) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a copy. For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself. It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable that you distribute. 6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also compile or link a "work that uses the Library" with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications. 7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do these two things: You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things: a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the Sections above. b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work. a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for the Library including whateve changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machinereadable "work that uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.) 8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance. 9. You are not required to accept this License, since 79 you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based on it. copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the Library General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this License. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library. 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally. NO WARRANTY 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License. THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE 80 LAW OR AGREED TO IN freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these things. WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it. CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library. GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 2.1, February 1999 Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the original author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced by others. 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. [This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license. Preamble The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non-free programs. This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated software packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below. When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public When we speak of free software, we are referring to 81 License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these terms. A "work based on the Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special circumstances. "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the library. For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License. Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that uses the Library does. In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in nonfree programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the Library. Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a "work based on the library" and a "work that uses the library". The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must be combined with the library in order to run. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee. 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE a) The modified work must itself be a software library. TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent noticesstating that you changed the files and the date of any change. 0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also called "this License"). Each licensee is addressed as "you". c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License. d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and data) to form executables. 82 such function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful. terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange. If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code. (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is entirely welldefined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still compute square roots.) 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a "work that uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this License. These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the library". The executable is therefore covered by this License. Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables. When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License. If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these notices. Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself. Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy. 6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications. This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a program that is not a library. 4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be distributed under the You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must 83 include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things: based on the Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do these two things: a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machinereadable "work that uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.) a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the Sections above. b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work. 8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance. b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library already present on the user's computer syste rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version is interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with. 9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based on it. c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more than the cost of performing this distribution. d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the same place. 10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License. e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a copy. For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable that you 7. You may place library facilities that are a work 84 through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library. generally. NO WARRANTY If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License. THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. 12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License. 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS Other 85 name License Chromium URL: http://www.chromium.org Copyright (c) 2013 The Chromium Authors. All rights reserved. chromium-nss.h chromium-blapi.h Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: chromium-blapit.h chromium-sha256.h * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright chromium-prtypes.h notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. The following files contain portions distributed under the MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 tri-license: * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above registry_controlled_domains/registry_controlled_dom ain.cc copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer registry_controlled_domains/registry_controlled_dom ain.h in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the The following files are distributed under the MPL 2.0 license: * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from Fontconfig this software without specific prior written permission. URL: http://www.fontconfig.org THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS Copyright © 2000,2001,2002,2003,2004,2006,2007 Keith Packard "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT Copyright © 2005 Patrick Lam LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR Copyright © 2008,2009 Red Hat, Inc. Copyright © 2009 Roozbeh Pournader Copyright © 2008 Danilo Šegan A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT documentation, and that the name of the author(s) not be used in (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. specific, written prior permission. The authors make no representations about the suitability of this software for any purpose. It -- is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty. The following files are distributed under the MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 tri-license: THE AUTHOR(S) DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH 86 REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, "Freely Available" means that you have the freedom to copy or modify the Font as well as redistribute copies of the Font under the same conditions you received, not price. If you wish, you can charge for this service. INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR(S) BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of this Font in any medium, without restriction, provided that you retain this license file (ARPHICPL.TXT) unaltered in all copies. CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER You may otherwise modify your copy of this Font in any way, including modifying glyph, reordering glyph, converting format, changing font name, or adding/deleting some characters in/from glyph table, and copy and distribute such modifications under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that the following conditions are met: TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. Arphic fonts a) You must insert a prominent notice in each modified file stating how and when you changed that file. URL: http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/CJKUnifo nts/Download b) You must make such modifications Freely Available as a whole to all third parties under the terms of this License, such as by offering access to copy the modifications from a designated place, or distributing the modifications on a medium customarily used for software interchange. ARPHIC PUBLIC LICENSE Copyright (C) 1999 Arphic Technology Co., Ltd. All rights reserved except as specified below. c) If the modified fonts normally reads commands interactively when run, you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the Font under these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this License. Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is forbidden. Preamble The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the ARPHIC PUBLIC LICENSE specifically permits and encourages you to use this software, provided that you give the recipients all the rights that we gave you and make sure they can get the modifications of this software. These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Font, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. Therefore, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Font with the Font on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License. Legal Terms Throughout this License, "Font" means the TrueType fonts "AR PL Mingti2L Big5", "AR PL KaitiM Big5" (BIG-5 character set) and "AR PL SungtiL GB", "AR PL KaitiM GB" (GB character set) which are originally distributed by Arphic, and the derivatives of those fonts created through any modification including modifying glyph, reordering glyph, converting format, changing font name, or adding/deleting some characters in/from glyph table. "Copyright Holder" means whoever is named in the copyright or copyrights for the Font. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Font except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Font will automatically retroactively void your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License will keep their licenses valid so long as such parties remain in full compliance. "You" means the licensee, or person copying, redistributing or modifying the Font. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants "PL" means "Public License". 87 you permission to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Font. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by copying, modifying, sublicensing or distributing the Font, you indicate your acceptance of this License and all its terms and conditions. USE, DATA OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDERS OR OTHER PARTIES HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Bitstream Vera fonts Each time you redistribute the Font, the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Font subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this License. URL: http://www.gnome.org/fonts/#Final_Bitstream_Vera _Fonts Bitstream Vera Fonts Copyright The fonts have a generous copyright, allowing derivative works (as long as "Bitstream" or "Vera" are not in the names), and full redistribution (so long as they are not *sold* by themselves). They can be be bundled, redistributed and sold with any software. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Font at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Font by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Font. The fonts are distributed under the following copyright: Copyright ========= Copyright (c) 2003 by Bitstream, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Bitstream Vera is a trademark of Bitstream, Inc. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of the fonts accompanying this license ("Fonts") and associated If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. documentation files (the "Font Software"), to reproduce and distribute the Font Software, including without limitation the rights to use, BECAUSE THE FONT IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE FONT, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE FONT "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE FONT IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE FONT PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. copy, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Font Software, and to permit persons to whom the Font Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: The above copyright and trademark notices and this permission notice shall be included in all copies of one or more of the Font Software The Font Software may be modified, altered, or added to, and in UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING, IN NO EVENT WILL ANY COPYRIGHTT HOLDERS, OR OTHER PARTIES WHO MAY COPY, MODIFY OR REDISTRIBUTE THE FONT AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE FONT (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF particular the designs of glyphs or characters in the Fonts may be modified and additional glyphs or characters may be added to the Fonts, only if the fonts are renamed to names not containing either the words "Bitstream" or the word "Vera". 88 This License becomes null and void to the extent applicable to Fonts a font sale system and sell them as is. It seems fair that if Bitstream can't make money or Font Software that has been modified and is distributed under the "Bitstream Vera" names. from the Bitstream Vera fonts, their competitors should not be able to The Font Software may be sold as part of a larger software package but do so either. You can sell the fonts as part of any software package, no copy of one or more of the Font Software typefaces may be sold by itself. however. 2. I want to package these fonts separately for distribution and THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, sale as part of a larger software package or system. Can I do so? EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTIES OF Yes. A RPM or Debian package is a "larger software package" to begin MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT with, and you aren't selling them independently by themselves. OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT, TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL See 1. above. BITSTREAM OR THE GNOME FOUNDATION BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR 3. Are derivative works allowed? OTHER LIABILITY, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, Yes! OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR 4. Can I change or add to the font(s)? OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE FONT Yes, but you must change the name(s) of the font(s). SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT SOFTWARE. 5. Under what terms are derivative works allowed? You must change the name(s) of the fonts. This is to ensure the Except as contained in this notice, the names of Gnome, the Gnome quality of the fonts, both to protect Bitstream and Gnome. We want to Foundation, and Bitstream Inc., shall not be used in advertising or ensure that if an application has opened a font specifically of these otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Font names, it gets what it expects (though of course, using fontconfig, Software without prior written authorization from the Gnome Foundation substitutions could still could have occurred during font or Bitstream Inc., respectively. For further information, contact: fonts at gnome dot org. opening). You must include the Bitstream copyright. Additional Copyright FAQ copyrights can be added, as per copyright law. Happy Font Hacking! ============= 6. If I have improvements for Bitstream Vera, is it possible they might get 1. I don't understand the resale restriction... What gives? adopted in future versions? Bitstream is giving away these fonts, but wishes to ensure its Yes. The contract between the Gnome Foundation and Bitstream has competitors can't just drop the fonts as is into 89 provisions for working with Bitstream to ensure quality additions to URL: http://www.google.com/fonts/specimen/Open+Sans the Bitstream Vera font family. Please contact us if you have such additions. Note, that in general, we will want such additions for the License for Open Sans Font Family -------------------------------- entire family, not just a single font, and that you'll have to keep Apache License both Gnome and Jim Lyles, Vera's designer, happy! To make sense to add January 2004 Version 2.0, glyphs to the font, they must be stylistically in keeping with Vera's http://www.apache.org/licenses/ design. Vera cannot become a "ransom note" font. Jim Lyles will be TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION providing a document describing the design elements used in Vera, as a 1. Definitions. guide and aid for people interested in contributing to Vera. "License" shall mean the terms and conditions for use, reproduction, 7. I want to sell a software package that uses these fonts: Can I do so? and distribution as defined by Sections 1 through 9 of this document. Sure. Bundle the fonts with your software and sell your software "Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by with the fonts. That is the intent of the copyright. the copyright owner that is granting the License. "Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting entity and all 8. If applications have built the names "Bitstream Vera" into them, other entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common can I override this somehow to use fonts of my choosing? control with that entity. For the purposes of this definition, This depends on exact details of the software. Most open source "control" means (i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the systems and software (e.g., Gnome, KDE, etc.) are now converting to direction or management of such entity, whether by contract or use fontconfig (see www.fontconfig.org) to handle font configuration, otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or more of the selection and substitution; it has provisions for overriding font outstanding shares, or (iii) beneficial ownership of such entity. names and subsituting alternatives. An example is provided by the "You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal Entity supplied local.conf file, which chooses the family Bitstream Vera for exercising permissions granted by this License. "sans", "serif" and "monospace". Other software (e.g., the XFree86 "Source" form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications, core server) has other mechanisms for font substitution. including but not limited to software source code, documentation source, and configuration files. "Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical Open Sans fonts 90 transformation or translation of a Source form, including but excluding communication that is conspicuously marked or otherwise not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation, designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a Contribution." and conversions to other media types. "Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity "Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or on behalf of whom a Contribution has been received by Licensor and Object form, made available under the License, as indicated by a subsequently incorporated within the Work. copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work 2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms and conditions of (an example is provided in the Appendix below). this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual, "Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royaltyfree, irrevocable form, that is based on (or derived from) the Work and for which the copyright license to reproduce, prepare Derivative Works of, editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications publicly display, publicly perform, sublicense, and distribute the represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship. For the purposes Work and such Derivative Works in Source or Object form. of this License, Derivative Works shall not include works that remain separable from, or merely link (or bind by name) to the interfaces of, 3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of the Work and Derivative Works thereof. this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual, "Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royaltyfree, irrevocable the original version of the Work and any modifications or additions (except as stated in this section) patent license to make, have made, to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally use, offer to sell, sell, import, and otherwise transfer the Work, submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner where such license applies only to those patent claims licensable or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of by such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their the copyright owner. For the purposes of this definition, "submitted" Contribution(s) alone or by combination of their Contribution(s) means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent with the Work to which such Contribution(s) was submitted. If You to the Licensor or its representatives, including but not limited to institute patent litigation against any entity (including a communication on electronic mailing lists, source code control systems, cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that the Work and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct Licensor for the purpose of discussing and improving the Work, but or contributory patent infringement, then any 91 patent licenses normally appear. The contents granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and as of the date such litigation is filed. do not modify the License. You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works that You distribute, alongside 4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided Work or Derivative Works thereof in any medium, with or without that such additional attribution notices cannot be construed modifications, and in Source or Object form, provided that You as modifying the License. meet the following conditions: You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and (a) You must give any other recipients of the Work or may provide additional or different license terms and conditions Derivative Works a copy of this License; and for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications, or (b) You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices for any such Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use, stating that You changed the files; and (c) You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works reproduction, and distribution of the Work otherwise complies with that You distribute, all copyright, patent, trademark, and the conditions stated in this License. attribution notices from the Source form of the Work, 5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explicitly state otherwise, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of any Contribution intentionally submitted for inclusion in the Work the Derivative Works; and by You to the Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions of (d) If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its this License, without any additional terms or conditions. distribution, then any Derivative Works that You distribute must Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein shall supersede or modify include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained the terms of any separate license agreement you may have executed within such NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not with Licensor regarding such Contributions. pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at least one of the following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed 6. Trademarks. This License does not grant permission to use the trade as part of the Derivative Works; within the Source form or names, trademarks, service marks, or product names of the Licensor, documentation, if provided along with the Derivative Works; or, except as required for reasonable and customary use in describing the within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the NOTICE file. wherever such third-party notices 92 7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by applicable law or or other liability obligations and/or rights consistent with this agreed to in writing, Licensor provides the Work (and each License. However, in accepting such obligations, You may act only Contributor provides its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS, on Your own behalf and on Your sole responsibility, not on behalf WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or of any other Contributor, and only if You agree to indemnify, implied, including, without limitation, any warranties or conditions defend, and hold each Contributor harmless for any liability of TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or FITNESS FOR A incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely responsible for determining the of your accepting any such warranty or additional liability. appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and assume any END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS risks associated with Your exercise of permissions under this License. APPENDIX: How to apply the Apache License to your work. 8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no legal theory, To apply the Apache License to your work, attach the following whether in tort (including negligence), contract, or otherwise, boilerplate notice, with the fields enclosed by brackets "[]" unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly replaced with your own identifying information. (Don't include negligent acts) or agreed to in writing, shall any Contributor be the brackets!) The text should be enclosed in the appropriate liable to You for damages, including any direct, indirect, special, comment syntax for the file format. We also recommend that a incidental, or consequential damages of any character arising as a file or class name and description of purpose be included on the result of this License or out of the use or inability to use the same "printed page" as the copyright notice for easier Work (including but not limited to damages for loss of goodwill, identification within third-party archives. work stoppage, computer failure or malfunction, or any and all Copyright [yyyy] [name of copyright owner] other commercial damages or losses), even if such Contributor has been advised of the possibility of such damages. Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. 9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While redistributing You may obtain a copy of the License at the Work or Derivative Works thereof, You may choose to offer, and charge a fee for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity, http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 93 Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software All rights reserved. distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions See the License for the specific language governing permissions and are met: this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. limitations under the License. this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation VL Gothic fonts and/or other materials provided with the distribution. URL: http://dicey.org/vlgothic/index.html License for VLGothic Font Family the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products -------------------------------- derived from this software without specific prior written permission. This font includes glyphs derived from M+ FONTS which is created by M+ FONTS PROJECT. License for M+ FONTS part is described in M+ FONTS THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY WADA LABORATORY, THE UNIVERSITY OF TOKYO AND PROJECT's license. See attached 'LICENSE_E.mplus'. CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT This font also includes glyphs derived from Sazanami Gothic font which NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A is created by Electronic Font Open Laboratory (/efont/). License for PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE LABORATORY OR Sazanami Gothic part is described in it's license. See attached CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, 'README.sazanami' for original Sazanami Gothic font license. EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, This font also includes original glyphs which is created by Daisuke PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; SUZUKI and Project Vine based on M+ FONTS. Licese for VL Gothic OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, original glyphs is same as M+ FONTS PROJECT's license. WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR There is no limitation and the below description is not applied OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF as for in order not to reuse as font (ex: font is embeded to documents). ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Copyright (c) 1990-2003 Wada Laboratory, the University of Tokyo. Nanum fonts Copyright (c) 2003-2004 Electronic Font Open Laboratory (/efont/). URL: http://hangeul.naver.com/ Copyright (c) 2010, NAVER Corporation (http://www.nhncorp.com), Copyright (C) 2003-2009 M+ FONTS PROJECT Copyright (C) 2006-2009 Daisuke SUZUKI. with Reserved Font Name Nanum, Naver Nanum, NanumGothic, Naver NanumGothic, NanumMyeongjo, Naver NanumMyeongjo, NanumBrush, Naver NanumBrush, NanumPen, Naver NanumPen, Naver NanumGothicEco, Copyright (C) 2006-2009 Project Vine . 94 NanumGothicEco, Naver NanumMyeongjoEco, NanumMyeongjoEco, Naver NanumGothicLight, NanumGothicLight, NanumBarunGothic, Naver NanumBarunGothic, Version, by changing formats or by porting the Font Software to a new environment. "Author" refers to any designer, engineer, programmer, technical writer or other person who contributed to the Font Software. This Font Software is licensed under the SIL Open Font License, Version 1.1. PERMISSION & CONDITIONS This license is copied below, and is also available with a FAQ at: http://scripts.sil.org/OFL Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining This Font Software is licensed under the SIL Open Font License, Version 1.1. a copy of the Font Software, to use, study, copy, merge, embed, modify, This license is copied below, and is also available with a FAQ at: redistribute, and sell modified and unmodified copies of the Font http://scripts.sil.org/OFL Software, subject to the following conditions: ---------------------------------------------------------- 1) Neither the Font Software nor any of its individual components, SIL OPEN FONT LICENSE Version 1.1 - 26 February 2007 in Original or Modified Versions, may be sold by itself. ---------------------------------------------------------- 2) Original or Modified Versions of the Font Software may be bundled, redistributed and/or sold with any software, provided that each copy PREAMBLE The goals of the Open Font License (OFL) are to stimulate worldwide development of collaborative font projects, to support the font creation efforts of academic and linguistic communities, and to provide a free and open framework in which fonts may be shared and improved in partnership with others. contains the above copyright notice and this license. These can be included either as stand-alone text files, humanreadable headers or in the appropriate machine-readable metadata fields within text or The OFL allows the licensed fonts to be used, studied, modified and redistributed freely as long as they are not sold by themselves. The fonts, including any derivative works, can be bundled, embedded, redistributed and/or sold with any software provided that any reserved names are not used by derivative works. The fonts and derivatives, however, cannot be released under any other type of license. The requirement for fonts to remain under this license does not apply to any document created using the fonts or their derivatives. binary files as long as those fields can be easily viewed by the user. 3) No Modified Version of the Font Software may use the Reserved Font Name(s) unless explicit written permission is granted by the corresponding Copyright Holder. This restriction only applies to the primary font name as DEFINITIONS presented to the users. "Font Software" refers to the set of files released by the Copyright Holder(s) under this license and clearly marked as such. This may include source files, build scripts and documentation. 4) The name(s) of the Copyright Holder(s) or the Author(s) of the Font "Reserved Font Name" refers to any names specified as such after the copyright statement(s). Software shall not be used to promote, endorse or advertise any "Original Version" refers to the collection of Font Software components as distributed by the Copyright Holder(s). Modified Version, except to acknowledge the contribution(s) of the Copyright Holder(s) and the Author(s) or with their explicit written "Modified Version" refers to any derivative made by adding to, deleting, or substituting -- in part or in whole -- any of the components of the Original 95 5) The Font Software, modified or unmodified, in part or in whole, GNU LIBRARY GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 2, June 1991 must be distributed entirely under this license, and must not be Copyright (C) 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA distributed under any other license. The requirement for fonts to Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. remain under this license does not apply to any document created using the Font Software. [This is the first released version of the library GPL. It is numbered 2 because it goes with version 2 of the ordinary GPL.] TERMINATION This license becomes null and void if any of the above conditions are Preamble not met. The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. DISCLAIMER THE FONT SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, This license, the Library General Public License, applies to some specially designated Free Software Foundation software, and to any other libraries whose authors decide to use it. You can use it for your libraries, too. EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHT, PATENT, TRADEMARK, OR OTHER RIGHT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things. COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library, or if you modify it. FROM, OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE FONT SOFTWARE OR FROM OTHER DEALINGS IN THE FONT SOFTWARE. For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. If you link a program with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients so that they can relink them with the library, after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. Mini-XML URL: http://www.msweet.org/projects.php?Z3 Mini-XML License The Mini-XML library and included programs are provided under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License version 2 (LGPL2) with the following exceptions: Our method of protecting your rights has two steps: (1) copyright the library, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library. If you link the application to a modified version of Mini-XML, then the changes to Mini-XML must be provided under the terms of the LGPL2 in sections 1, 2, and 4. Also, for each distributor's protection, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is 96 no warranty for this free library. If the library is modified by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original version, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors' reputations. this special one. TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and data) to form executables. Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that companies distributing free software will individually obtain patent licenses, thus in effect transforming the program into proprietary software. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these terms. A "work based on the Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License, which was designed for utility programs. This license, the GNU Library General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries. This license is quite different from the ordinary one; be sure to read it in full, and don't assume that anything in it is the same as in the ordinary license. "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the library. The reason we have a separate public license for some libraries is that they blur the distinction we usually make between modifying or adding to a program and simply using it. Linking a program with a library, without changing the library, is in some sense simply using the library, and is analogous to running a utility program or application program. However, in a textual and legal sense, the linked executable is a combined work, a derivative of the original library, and the ordinary General Public License treats it as such. Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that uses the Library does. Because of this blurred distinction, using the ordinary General Public License for libraries did not effectively promote software sharing, because most developers did not use the libraries. We concluded that weaker conditions might promote sharing better. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee. a) The modified work must itself be a software library. However, unrestricted linking of non-free programs would deprive the users of those programs of all benefit from the free status of the libraries themselves. This Library General Public License is intended to permit developers of non-free programs to use free libraries, while preserving your freedom as a user of such programs to change the free libraries that are incorporated in them. (We have not seen how to achieve this as regards changes in header files, but we have achieved it as regards changes in the actual functions of the Library.) The hope is that this will lead to faster development of free libraries. b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License. d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a "work based on the libary" and a "work that uses the library". The former contains code derived from the library, while the latter only works together with the library. (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is entirely welldefined independent of the application. Therefore, Note that it is possible for a library to be covered by the ordinary General Public License rather than by 97 Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still compute square roots.) data structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself. You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things: Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library. a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machine-readable "work that uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.) In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License. Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy. This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a program that is not a library. b) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more than the cost of performing this distribution. If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code. c) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the same place. However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the library". The executable is therefore covered by this License. Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables. d) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a copy. For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. It may happen that this requirement contradicts the If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, 98 license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable that you distribute. To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the Sections above. one line to give the library's name and an idea of what it does. Copyright (C) year name of author b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work. This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names: This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License. Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. signature of Ty Coon, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon, President of Vice That's all there is to it! Boost URL: http://www.boost.org/ Boost Software License - Version 1.0 - August 17th, 2003 NO WARRANTY END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person or organization How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries obtaining a copy of the software and accompanying documentation covered by If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making it free software that everyone can redistribute and change. You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary General Public License). this license (the "Software") to use, reproduce, display, distribute, execute, and transmit the Software, and to prepare derivative works of the Software, and to permit third-parties to whom the Software is furnished to 99 do so, all subject to the following: DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE The copyright notices in the Software and this entire statement, including OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. the above license grant, this restriction and the following disclaimer, Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not must be included in all copies of the Software, in whole or in part, and be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings all derivative works of the Software, unless such copies or derivative in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder. works are solely in the form of machine-executable object code generated by a source language processor. libcurl - lib/krb5.c URL: https://github.com/bagder/curl/blob/master/lib/krb5 .c THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR /* GSSAPI/krb5 support for FTP - loosely based on old krb4.c IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT * Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2013 Kungliga Tekniska Högskolan SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE LIABLE * (Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden). FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, * Copyright (c) 2004 - 2012 Daniel Stenberg ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER * All rights reserved. * DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without libcurl * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions URL: http://curl.haxx.se/ * are met: COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE * Copyright (c) 1996 - 2014, Daniel Stenberg, . * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright All rights reserved. * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose * with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, * FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, * 100 may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software * * (Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden). without specific prior written permission. * * * Copyright (C) 2001 - 2013, Daniel Stenberg, , et al. * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND * * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE * All rights reserved. * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE * * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL * are met: * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS * * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT * * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the * SUCH DAMAGE. */ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. libcurl - lib/security.c * URL: https://github.com/bagder/curl/blob/master/lib/secu rity.c * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software /* This source code was modified by Martin Hedenfalk for * without specific prior written permission. * * use in Curl. His latest changes were done 2000-09-18. * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND * * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE * It has since been patched and modified a lot by Daniel Stenberg * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE * to make it better applied to curl conditions, and to make * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE * it not use globals, pollute name space and more. This source code awaits a * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL * rewrite to work around the paragraph 2 in the BSD licenses as explained * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS * below. * * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) * Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2013 Kungliga Tekniska Högskolan * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF 101 LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT with or without * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF * met: * * SUCH DAMAGE. */ * * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright David M. Gay's floating point routines * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. URL: http://www.netlib.org/fp/ * * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its /********************************************************* ******* * contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from * * The author of this software is David M. Gay. * this software without specific prior written permission. * * Copyright (c) 1991, 2000, 2001 by Lucent Technologies. * * * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT * purpose without fee is hereby granted, provided that this entire notice * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR * is included in all copies of any software which is or includes a copy * A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT * or modification of this software and in all copies of the supporting * OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, * documentation for such software. * * SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT * THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED * LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, * WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE AUTHOR NOR LUCENT MAKES ANY * DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY * REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY * THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT * OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. * (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE * * OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ******************************************************** *******/ * * --- dynamic annotations * Author: Kostya Serebryany URL: http://code.google.com/p/data-racetest/wiki/DynamicAnnotations */ /* Copyright (c) 2008-2009, Google Inc. libevent * All rights reserved. URL: http://libevent.org/ * Libevent is available for use under the following license, commonly known * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, 102 as the 3-clause (or "modified") BSD license: available in the corresponding source files; the license is as above. Here's a list: ============================== Copyright (c) 2000-2007 Niels Provos Copyright (c) 2000 Dug Song Copyright (c) 2007-2010 Niels Provos and Nick Mathewson Copyright (c) 1993 The Regents of the University of California. Copyright (c) 1998 Todd C. Miller Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without Copyright (c) 2003 Michael A. Davis modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions Copyright (c) 2007 Sun Microsystems are met: Copyright (c) 2006 Maxim Yegorushkin notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Copyright 2002 Niels Provos notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. Netscape Portable Runtime (NSPR) derived from this software without specific prior written permission. URL: http://www.mozilla.org/projects/nspr/ /* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK ***** * Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR * * The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES * 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. * the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, * http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT * NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, * Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY * WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT * for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF * License. THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. * The Original Code is the Netscape Portable Runtime (NSPR). ============================== * * * The Initial Developer of the Original Code is Portions of Libevent are based on works by others, also made available by * Netscape Communications Corporation. * Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 1998-2000 them under the three-clause BSD license above. The copyright notices are 103 * the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or * other materials provided with the distribution. * Contributor(s): * Neither my name, Paul Hsieh, nor the names of any other contributors to the * * Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of code use may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this * either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or software without specific prior written permission. * the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND * in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL are applicable instead ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED * of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE * under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES * use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; * decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON * and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT * the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS * the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. * * ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */ google-glog's symbolization library URL: https://github.com/google/glog Paul Hsieh's SuperFastHash Copyright (c) 2006, Google Inc. URL: http://www.azillionmonkeys.com/qed/hash.html All rights reserved. Paul Hsieh OLD BSD license Copyright (c) 2010, Paul Hsieh Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: All rights reserved. * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT 104 HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS disclaimer. "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT 2. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR not claim that you wrote the original software. If you use this A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT software in a product, an acknowledgment in the product OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, documentation would be appreciated but is not required. SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT 3. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, not be misrepresented as being the original software. DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY 4. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT products derived from this software without specific prior written (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE permission. OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED valgrind URL: http://valgrind.org WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY Notice that the following BSD-style license applies to the Valgrind header DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL files used by Chromium (valgrind.h and memcheck.h). However, the rest of DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE Valgrind is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public License, GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS version 2, unless otherwise indicated. INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, --------------------------------------------------------------- WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING Copyright (C) 2000-2008 Julian Seward. All rights reserved. NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions Mozilla Personal Security Manager URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/mozillacentral/source/security/manager/ are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright /* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK ***** notice, this list of conditions and the following * Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 105 * * the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. * The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version * * 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with * ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */ * the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at Network Security Services (NSS) * http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ URL: http://www.mozilla.org/projects/security/pki/nss/ * * Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, /* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK ***** * Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 * WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License * * for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the * The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version * License. * 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with * * the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at * The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries. * * http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ * The Initial Developer of the Original Code is * * Netscape Communications Corporation. * Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, * Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 2000 * WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License * the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. * * for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the * Contributor(s): * License. * * * Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of * The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries. * either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or * * The Initial Developer of the Original Code is * the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), * Netscape Communications Corporation. * Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 1994-2000 * in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL are applicable instead * the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. * of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only * * under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to * Contributor(s): * use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your * Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of * decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice * either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or * and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete * the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), * the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under * in which case the provisions of the GPL or the * 106 LGPL are applicable instead NO EVENT SHALL THE * of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, * under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, * use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; * decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER * and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT * the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN * the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THEPOSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. * * ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */ boringssl URL: https://boringssl.googlesource.com/boringssl open-vcdiff URL: https://github.com/google/open-vcdiff LICENSE ISSUES ============== Almost Native Graphics Layer Engine The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the conditions of URL: http://code.google.com/p/angleproject/ Copyright (C) 2002-2013 The ANGLE Project Authors. the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay license apply to the toolkit. All rights reserved. See below for the actual license texts. Actually both licenses are BSD-style Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Open Source licenses. In case of any license issues related to OpenSSL Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. please contact openssl-core@openssl.org. OpenSSL License Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. --------------- /* ============================================== ====================== Neither the name of TransGaming Inc., Google Inc., 3DLabs Inc. Ltd., nor the names of their contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. * Copyright (c) 1998-2011 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved. * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS * are met: * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN 107 * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * * PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright * ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in * SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT * the documentation and/or other materials provided with the * NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; * * LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) distribution. * * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) * software must display the following acknowledgment: * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED * "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. * for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)" * ============================================== ====================== * * * 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to * This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young * endorse or promote products derived from this software without * (eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim * prior written permission. For written permission, please contact * * Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). openssl-core@openssl.org. * * */ * 5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" Original SSLeay License * nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written * ----------------------- permission of the OpenSSL Project. * /* Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) * 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following * All rights reserved. * * acknowledgment: * This package is an SSL implementation written * "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project * by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). * for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)" * The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL. * * * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY * This library is free for commercial and noncommercial use as long as * EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, * the following conditions are aheared to. The 108 following conditions * the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement: * apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, * "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)" * lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation * * included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND * except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE * * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE * Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE * the code are not to be removed. * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL * If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS * as the author of the parts of the library used. * This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) * in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package. * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT * * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions * SUCH DAMAGE. * are met: * * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright * The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright * copied and put under another distribution licence * [including the GNU Public Licence.] * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the */ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. Brotli * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software * URL: https://github.com/google/brotli must display the following acknowledgement: Google Cache Invalidation API * "This product includes cryptographic software written by * URL: https://chromium.googlesource.com/chromium/src/+ /master/third_party/cacheinvalidation/README.chro mium Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)" * The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the library * being used are not cryptographic related :-). Crashpad * 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from URL: https://crashpad.chromium.org/ 109 drawElements Quality Program DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY URL: https://source.android.com/devices/graphics/testing. html THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE dom-distiller-js OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. URL: https://github.com/chromium/dom-distiller Copyright 2014 The Chromium Authors. All rights reserved. Parts of the following directories are available under Apache v2.0 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are src/de met: Copyright (c) 2009-2011 Christian Kohlschütter * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright third_party/gwt_exporter Copyright 2007 Timepedia.org notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. third_party/gwt-2.5.1 * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above Copyright 2008 Google copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer java/org/chromium/distiller/dev in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the Copyright 2008 Google * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its Apache License contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from Version 2.0, January 2004 this software without specific prior written permission. http://www.apache.org/licenses/ THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR "License" shall mean the terms and conditions for use, reproduction, and distribution as defined by Sections 1 through 9 of this document. A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, "Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by the copyright owner that is granting the License. SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, 110 "Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting entity and all other entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common control with that entity. For the purposes of this definition, "control" means (i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by contract or otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or more of the outstanding shares, or (iii) beneficial ownership of such entity. improving the Work, but excluding communication that is conspicuously marked or otherwise designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a Contribution." "Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution has been received by Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work. You must give any other recipients of the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this License; and "You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal Entity exercising permissions granted by this License. You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices stating that You changed the files; and "Source" form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications, including but not limited to software source code, documentation source, and configuration files. You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works that You distribute, all copyright, patent, trademark, and attribution notices from the Source form of the Work, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works; and "Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical transformation or translation of a Source form, including but not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation, and conversions to other media types. If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its distribution, then any Derivative Works that You distribute must include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained within such NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at least one of the following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed as part of the Derivative Works; within the Source form or documentation, if provided along with the Derivative Works; or, within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and wherever such third-party notices normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and do not modify the License. You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works that You distribute, alongside or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided that such additional attribution notices cannot be construed as modifying the License. "Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or Object form, made available under the License, as indicated by a copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work (an example is provided in the Appendix below). "Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object form, that is based on (or derived from) the Work and for which the editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship. For the purposes of this License, Derivative Works shall not include works that remain separable from, or merely link (or bind by name) to the interfaces of, the Work and Derivative Works thereof. You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and may provide additional or different license terms and conditions for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications, or for any such Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use, reproduction, and distribution of the Work otherwise complies with the conditions stated in this License. "Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including the original version of the Work and any modifications or additions to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner. For the purposes of this definition, "submitted" means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent to the Licensor or its representatives, including but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists, source code control systems, and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the Licensor for the purpose of discussing and END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS Expat XML Parser URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/expat/ Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd and Clark 111 Cooper are met: Copyright (c) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Expat maintainers. 1.Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the 2.Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to 3.The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to derived from this software without specific prior written permission. the following conditions: THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. fips181 URL: http://www.adel.nursat.kz/apg/ Copyright (c) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 flac Adel I. Mirzazhanov. All rights reserved URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/flac/files/flacsrc/flac-1.2.1-src/flac-1.2.1.tar.gz/download Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without Copyright (C) 2000,2001,2002,2003,2004,2005,2006,2007 Josh Coalson modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions 112 harfbuzz-ng Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without URL: http://harfbuzz.org modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions HarfBuzz is licensed under the so-called "Old MIT" license. Details follow. are met: For parts of HarfBuzz that are licensed under different licenses see individual - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright files names COPYING in subdirectories where applicable. notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Copyright © 2010,2011,2012 Google, Inc. Copyright © 2012 Mozilla Foundation - Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright Copyright © 2011 Codethink Limited Copyright © 2008,2010 Nokia Corporation and/or its subsidiary(-ies) notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the Copyright © 2009 Keith Stribley documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. Copyright © 2009 Martin Hosken and SIL International Copyright © 2007 Chris Wilson - Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its Copyright © 2006 Behdad Esfahbod Copyright © 2005 David Turner contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from Copyright © 2004,2007,2008,2009,2010 Red Hat, Inc. this software without specific prior written permission. Copyright © 1998-2004 David Turner and Werner Lemberg THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS For full copyright notices consult the individual files in the package. ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR Permission is hereby granted, without written agreement and without CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, license or royalty fees, to use, copy, modify, and distribute this EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, software and its documentation for any purpose, provided that the PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR above copyright notice and the following two paragraphs appear in PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF all copies of this software. LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY FOR NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE AND ITS DOCUMENTATION, EVEN 113 IF THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH the Independent JPEG Group". THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, full responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the authors accept BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind. (3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE SOFTWARE PROVIDED HEREUNDER IS These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code, ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, AND THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER HAS NO OBLIGATION TO not just to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you ought to PROVIDE MAINTENANCE, SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS. acknowledge us. iccjpeg Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author's name or company name URL: http://www.ijg.org in advertising or publicity relating to this software or products derived from it. The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation, either express or implied, This software may be referred to only as "the Independent JPEG Group's with respect to this software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or software". fitness for a particular purpose. This software is provided "AS IS", and you, We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality and accuracy. commercial products, provided that all warranty or liability claims are assumed by the product vendor. This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G. Lane. All Rights Reserved except as specified below. icu URL: http://site.icu-project.org/ Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this ICU License - ICU 1.8.1 and later software (or portions thereof) for any purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions: COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE (1) If any part of the source code for this software is distributed, then this Copyright (c) 1995-2014 International Business Machines Corporation and README file must be included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice others unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes to the original files All rights reserved. must be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation. (2) If only executable code is distributed, then the accompanying Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a documentation must state that "this software is based in part on the work of copy of this software and associated documentation files (the 114 "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including Third-Party Software Licenses without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, This section contains third-party software notices and/or additional distribute, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to terms for licensed third-party software components included within ICU whom the Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above libraries. copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all copies of 1. Unicode Data Files and Software the Software and that both the above copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation. COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE Copyright © 1991-2014 Unicode, Inc. All rights reserved. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS Distributed under the Terms of Use in OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF http://www.unicode.org/copyright.html. MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS a copy of the Unicode data files and any associated documentation INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT (the "Data Files") or Unicode software and any associated documentation OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS (the "Software") to deal in the Data Files or Software OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. the Data Files or Software, and to permit persons to whom the Data Files or Software are furnished to do so, provided that Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall (a) this copyright and permission notice appear with all copies not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or of the Data Files or Software, other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of (b) this copyright and permission notice appear in associated the copyright holder. documentation, and ________________________________________ ___________________________ (c) there is clear notice in each modified Data File or in the Software as well as in the documentation associated with the Data File(s) or All trademarks and registered trademarks mentioned herein are the Software that the data or software has been modified. property of their respective owners. ________________________________________ ___________________________ THE DATA FILES AND SOFTWARE ARE PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF 115 ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE is list of conditions and the following disclaimer. # Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS other materials provided with the distribution. # Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific DAMAGES, OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, prior written permission. DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER # # TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR # THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS I PERFORMANCE OF THE DATA FILES OR SOFTWARE. S" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPL Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder IED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLA shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, ECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDIN use or other dealings in these Data Files or Software without prior G, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, written authorization of the copyright holder. DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF L 2. Chinese/Japanese Word Break Dictionary Data (cjdict.txt) IABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED O # The Google Chrome software developed by Google is licensed under the BSD li F THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ses, as set forth below. # # # # The BSD License # The word list in cjdict.txt are generated by combining three word lists l # http://opensource.org/licenses/bsdlicense.php # isted Copyright (C) 2006-2008, Google Inc. # below with further processing for compound word breaking. The frequency i # # s generated All rights reserved. # # with an iterative training against Google web corpora. # Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifi # # cation, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: * Libtabe (Chinese) # - https://sourceforge.net/project/?group_id=1519 # # - Its license terms and conditions are shown below. # Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, th # 116 # * IPADIC (Japanese) # * REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, # - http://chasen.aistnara.ac.jp/chasen/distribution.html # * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES # - Its license terms and conditions are shown below. # * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR # # * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) # ---------COPYING.libtabe ---BEGIN-------------------- # * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, # # /* # * Copyrighy (c) 1999 TaBE Project. # * Copyright (c) 1999 Pai-Hsiang Hsiao. # * All rights reserved. # * # * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) # * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED # * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. # * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without # # * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions # # * are met: # * */ # /* # * Copyright (c) 1999 Computer Systems and Communication Lab, # * Institute of Information Science, Academia Sinica. # * . Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright # * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. # * All rights reserved. # * # * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without # * . Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright # * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions # * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in # * are met: # * the documentation and/or other materials provided with the # * # # * . Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright * distribution. # * . Neither the name of the TaBE Project nor the names of its # * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. # * contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived # * . Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright # * from this software without specific prior written permission. # # * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in * # * the documentation and/or other materials provided with the # * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS # # * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT * distribution. # * . Neither the name of the Computer Systems and Communication Lab # * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS # * nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or # * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE # * promote products derived from this software without specific 117 # * prior written permission. software is permitted. # * # Any copy of this software, whether in its original form or modified, # * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS # must include both the above copyright notice and the following # * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT # # * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS # # Nara Institute of Science and Technology (NAIST), # * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE # the copyright holders, disclaims all warranties with regard to this # * REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, # software, including all implied warranties of merchantability and # * INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES # # * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR fitness, in no event shall NAIST be liable for # any special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages # * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) # whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether in an # * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, # action of contract, negligence or other tortuous action, arising out # * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) # of or in connection with the use or performance of this software. # * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED # # # * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. # paragraphs. A large portion of the dictionary entries # originate from ICOT Free Software. The following conditions for ICOT */ # # Free Software applies to the current dictionary as well. # Copyright 1996 Chih-Hao Tsai @ Beckman Institute, University of Illinois # # Each User may also freely distribute the Program, whether in its # c-tsai4@uiuc.edu http://casper.beckman.uiuc.edu/~c-tsai4 # original form or modified, to any third party or parties, PROVIDED # # ---------------COPYING.libtabe-----END ----------------------------------- # that the provisions of Section 3 ("NO WARRANTY") will ALWAYS appear - # on, or be attached to, the Program, which is distributed substantially # # # in the same form as set out herein and that such intended # ---------------COPYING.ipadic-----BEGI N---------------------------------- # distribution, if actually made, will neither violate or otherwise -- # contravene any of the laws and regulations of the countries having # # Copyright 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Nara Institute of Science # # jurisdiction over the User or the intended distribution itself. and Technology. All Rights Reserved. # # # # Use, reproduction, and distribution of this 118 NO WARRANTY # # project or thereafter. Each user will be deemed to have agreed to the # The program was produced on an experimental basis in the course of the # foregoing by his or her commencement of use of the program. The term # research and development conducted during the project and is provided # "use" as used herein includes, but is not limited to, the use, # to users as so produced on an experimental basis. Accordingly, the # modification, copying and distribution of the program and the # program is provided without any warranty whatsoever, whether express, # production of secondary products from the program. # implied, statutory or otherwise. The term "warranty" used herein # # includes, but is not limited to, any warranty of the quality, # In the case where the program, whether in its original form or # performance, merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose of # modified, was distributed or delivered to or received by a user from # the program and the nonexistence of any infringement or violation of # any person, organization or entity other than ICOT, unless it makes or # # grants independently of ICOT any specific warranty to the user in any right of any third party. # # writing, such person, organization or entity, will also be exempted # Each user of the program will agree and understand, and be deemed to # from and not be held liable to the user for any such damages as noted # have agreed and understood, that there is no warranty whatsoever for # # the program and, accordingly, the entire risk arising from or above as far as the program is concerned. # # otherwise connected with the program is assumed by the user. # ---------------COPYING.ipadic-----END----------------------------------- # # Therefore, neither ICOT, the copyright holder, or any other 3. Lao Word Break Dictionary Data (laodict.txt) # organization that participated in or was otherwise related to the Copyright (c) 2013 International Business Machines Corporation and others. All Rights Reserved. # development of the program and their respective officials, directors, Project: http://code.google.com/p/laodictionary/ # officers and other employees shall be held liable for any and all Dictionary: http://laodictionary.googlecode.com/git/Lao-Dictionary.txt # damages, including, without limitation, general, special, incidental License: http://lao-dictionary.googlecode.com/g it/Lao-Dictionary-LICEN # and consequential damages, arising out of or otherwise in connection (copied below) This file is derived from the above dictionary, with slight modifications. # with the use or inability to use the program or any product, material ------------------------------------------------------------------------ # or result produced or otherwise obtained by using the program, # regardless of whether they have been advised of, or otherwise had Copyright (C) 2013 Brian Eugene Wilson, Robert Martin Campbell. # knowledge of, the possibility of such damages at any time during the All rights reserved. 119 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifi cation, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright no Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, tice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Redistributions this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of cond Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notic itions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materi e, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation an als provided with the distribution. d/or other materials provided with the distribution. Neither the name Myanmar Karen Word Lists, nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS I S" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMP LIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVIC DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED A ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DA ND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT MAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVIC (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF ES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED A THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. ND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT ------------------------------------------------------------------------ (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. 4. Burmese Word Break Dictionary Data (burmesedict.txt) ------------------------------------------------------------------------ Copyright (c) 2014 International Business Machines Corporation and others. All Rights Reserved. 5. Time Zone Database This list is part of a project hosted at: github.com/kanyawtech/myanmar-karen-word-lists ICU uses the public domain data and code derived from Time Zone Database ------------------------------------------------------------------------ for its time zone support. The ownership of the TZ database is explained in BCP 175: Procedure for Maintaining the Time Zone Database section 7. Copyright (c) 2013, LeRoy Benjamin Sharon All rights reserved. 120 1 - Database Ownership to do so, subject to the following conditions: The TZ database itself is not an IETF Contribution or an IETF The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included document. Rather it is a pre-existing and regularly updated work in all copies or substantial portions of the Materials. that is in the public domain, and is intended to remain in the public THE MATERIALS ARE PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, domain. Therefore, BCPs 78 [RFC5378] and 79 [RFC3979] do not apply EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF to the TZ Database or contributions that individuals make to it. MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. Should any claims be made and substantiated against the TZ Database, IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY the organization that is providing the IANA Considerations defined in CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, this RFC, under the memorandum of understanding with the IETF, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE currently ICANN, may act in accordance with all competent court MATERIALS OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE MATERIALS. orders. No ownership claims will be made by ICANN or the IETF Trust on the database or the code. Any person making a contribution to the SGI FREE SOFTWARE LICENSE B (Version 2.0, Sept. 18, 2008) database or code waives all rights to future claims in that contribution or in the TZ Database. Copyright (C) 1992 Silicon Graphics, Inc. All Rights Reserved. google-jstemplate URL: http://code.google.com/p/google-jstemplate/ Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of Khronos header files this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in URL: http://www.khronos.org/registry the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to Copyright (c) 2007-2010 The Khronos Group Inc. use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do copy of this software and/or associated documentation files (the so, subject to the following conditions: "Materials"), to deal in the Materials without restriction, including The above copyright notice including the dates of first publication and either without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, this permission notice or a reference to http://oss.sgi.com/projects/FreeB/ distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Materials, and to shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. permit persons to whom the Materials are furnished 121 products derived from THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR this software without specific prior written permission. IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL SILICON "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT GRAPHICS, INC. BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT Except as contained in this notice, the name of Silicon Graphics, Inc. shall LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from Silicon THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT Graphics, Inc. (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE LevelDB: A Fast Persistent Key-Value Store OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. URL: https://github.com/google/leveldb.git Copyright (c) 2011 The LevelDB Authors. All rights reserved. The library to input, validate, and display addresses. URL: https://github.com/googlei18n/libaddressinput Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are libjingle URL: http://www.webrtc.org met: libjpeg * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright URL: http://www.ijg.org/ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer The authors make NO WARRANTY or representation, either express or implied, in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the with respect to this software, its quality, accuracy, merchantability, or * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its fitness for a particular purpose. This software is provided "AS IS", and you, contributors may be used to endorse or promote its user, assume the entire risk as to its quality and 122 accuracy. liability claims are assumed by the product vendor. This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas G. Lane. All Rights Reserved except as specified below. sole proprietor of its copyright holder, Aladdin Enterprises of Menlo Park, CA. Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this by the usual distribution terms of the Free Software Foundation; principally, software (or portions thereof) for any purpose, without fee, subject to these that you must include source code if you redistribute it. (See the file ansi2knr.c for conditions: full details.) (1) If any part of the source code for this software is distributed, then this However, since ansi2knr.c is not needed as part of any program generated from the IJG code, this does not limit you more than README file must be included, with this copyright and no-warranty notice the foregoing paragraphs do. unaltered; and any additions, deletions, or changes to the original files The Unix configuration script "configure" was produced with GNU Autoconf. must be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation. It is copyright by the Free Software Foundation but is freely distributable. (2) If only executable code is distributed, then the accompanying The same holds for its supporting scripts (config.guess, config.sub, documentation must state that "this software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group". ltconfig, ltmain.sh). Another support script, install-sh, is copyright (3) Permission for use of this software is granted only if the user accepts by M.I.T. but is also freely distributable. full responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the authors accept It appears that the arithmetic coding option of the JPEG spec is covered by NO LIABILITY for damages of any kind. patents owned by IBM, AT&T, and Mitsubishi. Hence arithmetic coding cannot These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the IJG code, legally be used without obtaining one or more licenses. For this reason, not just to the unmodified library. If you use our work, you ought to support for arithmetic coding has been removed from the free JPEG software. acknowledge us. (Since arithmetic coding provides only a marginal gain over the unpatented Permission is NOT granted for the use of any IJG author's name or company name Huffman mode, it is unlikely that very many implementations will support it.) in advertising or publicity relating to this software or products derived from it. So far as we are aware, there are no patent restrictions on the remaining This software may be referred to only as "the Independent JPEG Group's The IJG distribution formerly included code to read and write GIF files. software". To avoid entanglement with the Unisys LZW patent, GIF reading support has We specifically permit and encourage the use of this software as the basis of been removed altogether, and the GIF writer has been simplified to produce commercial products, provided that all warranty or 123 "uncompressed GIFs". This technique does not use the LZW algorithm; the products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. resulting GIF files are larger than usual, but are readable by all standard THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS", GIF decoders. We are required to state that AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE "The Graphics Interchange Format(c) is the Copyright property of IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE CompuServe Incorporated. GIF(sm) is a Service Mark property of ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE CompuServe Incorporated." LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS Public License. INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN libjpeg-turbo CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE URL: http://sourceforge.net/projects/libjpeg-turbo/ POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. libjpeg-turbo is licensed under a non-restrictive, BSDstyle license International Phone Number Library (see README.) The TurboJPEG/OSS wrapper (both C and Java versions) and URL: http://libphonenumber.googlecode.com/svn/trunk/ associated test programs bear a similar license, which is reproduced below: Copyright (C) 2011 Google Inc. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, You may obtain a copy of the License at this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 - Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, and/or other materials provided with the distribution. WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. - Neither the name of the libjpeg-turbo Project nor the names of its See the License for the specific language governing permissions and contributors may be used to endorse or promote 124 limitations under the License. and the entire risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy, and effort is with libpng the user. URL: http://libpng.org/ libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6, March 20, 2000, are This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your convenience. In case of Copyright (c) 1998-2000 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, are derived from any discrepancy between this copy and the notices in the file png.h that is libpng-0.96, and are distributed according to the same disclaimer and included in the libpng distribution, the latter shall prevail. license as libpng-0.96, with the following individuals added to the list COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE: of Contributing Authors: If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices immediately following Tom Lane Glenn Randers-Pehrson this sentence. Willem van Schaik libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May 1997, are This code is released under the libpng license. Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Andreas Dilger, are derived from libpng-0.88, libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.54, November 12, 2015, are and are distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as Copyright (c) 2000-2002, 2004, 2006-2015 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, are libpng-0.88, with the following individuals added to the list of derived from libpng-1.0.6, and are distributed according to the same Contributing Authors: disclaimer and license as libpng-1.0.6 with the following individuals John Bowler added to the list of Contributing Authors: Kevin Bracey Sam Bushell Simon-Pierre Cadieux Magnus Holmgren Eric S. Raymond Greg Roelofs Cosmin Truta Tom Tanner Gilles Vollant libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January 1996, are and with the following additions to the disclaimer: Copyright (c) 1995-1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42, Inc. There is no warranty against interference with your enjoyment of the library or against infringement. There is no warranty that our For the purposes of this copyright and license, "Contributing Authors" efforts or the library will fulfill any of your particular purposes is defined as the following set of individuals: or needs. This library is provided with all faults, 125 Andreas Dilger Dave Martindale END OF COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE. Guy Eric Schalnat Paul Schmidt A "png_get_copyright" function is available, for convenient use in "about" Tim Wegner boxes and the like: The PNG Reference Library is supplied "AS IS". The Contributing Authors printf("%s", png_get_copyright(NULL)); and Group 42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed or implied, including, without limitation, the warranties of merchantability and of Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is supplied in the fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. files "pngbar.png.jpg" and "pngbar.jpg (88x31) and "pngnow.png.jpg" (98x31). assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental, special, exemplary, Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI Certified Open Source is or consequential damages, which may result from the use of the PNG a certification mark of the Open Source Initiative. OSI has not addressed Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of such damage. the additional disclaimers inserted at version 1.0.7. Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp at users.sourceforge.net source code, or portions hereof, for any purpose, without fee, subject November 12, 2015 to the following restrictions: libsrtp URL: https://github.com/cisco/libsrtp 1. The origin of this source code must not be misrepresented. /* 2. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such and must not * * Copyright (c) 2001-2006 Cisco Systems, Inc. be misrepresented as being the original source. * All rights reserved. * 3. This Copyright notice may not be removed or altered from any * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without source or altered source distribution. * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. specifically permit, without * are met: * fee, and encourage the use of this source code as a component to * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright supporting the PNG file format in commercial products. If you use this * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. source code in a product, acknowledgment is not required but would be * 126 * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above Copyright (c) 2010, The WebM Project authors. All rights reserved. * copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without * disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided * with the distribution. modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are * met: * Neither the name of the Cisco Systems, Inc. nor the names of its * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright * contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * from this software without specific prior written permission. * * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT the documentation and/or other materials provided with the * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS distribution. * FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE * Neither the name of Google, nor the WebM Project, nor the names * COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products * INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES derived from this software without specific prior written * (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR permission. * SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS * STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT * ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR * OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT * HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, */ SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT libusbx URL: http://libusb.org LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY libvpx URL: http://www.webmproject.org THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT 127 (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE litigation is filed. OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. libxml URL: http://xmlsoft.org Except where otherwise noted in the source code (e.g. the files hash.c, WebP image encoder/decoder URL: http://developers.google.com/speed/webp with different Copyright notices) all the files are: Additional IP Rights Grant (Patents) ------------------------------------ Copyright (C) 1998-2012 Daniel Veillard. All Rights Reserved. "These implementations" means the copyrightable works that implement the WebM Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy codecs distributed by Google as part of the WebM Project. of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights Google hereby grants to you a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell royalty-free, irrevocable (except as stated in this section) patent license to copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is fur- make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell, import, transfer, and otherwise nished to do so, subject to the following conditions: run, modify and propagate the contents of these implementations of WebM, where The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in such license applies only to those patent claims, both currently owned by all copies or substantial portions of the Software. Google and acquired in the future, licensable by Google that are necessarily THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR infringed by these implementations of WebM. This grant does not include claims IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT- that would be infringed only as a consequence of further modification of these NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE or agree to the institution of patent litigation or any other patent AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER enforcement activity against any entity (including a cross-claim or LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any of these implementations of WebM OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN or any code incorporated within any of these implementations of WebM THE SOFTWARE. constitute direct or contributory patent infringement, or inducement of libxslt patent infringement, then any patent rights granted to you under this License URL: http://xmlsoft.org/XSLT for these implementations of WebM shall terminate as of the date such Licence for libxslt except libexslt 128 --------------------------------------------------------------------- Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Thomas Broyer, Charlie Bozeman and Daniel Veillard. Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Daniel Veillard. All Rights Reserved. All Rights Reserved. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is fur- copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is fur- nished to do so, subject to the following conditions: nished to do so, subject to the following conditions: The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. all copies or substantial portions of the Software. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT- IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FIT- NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER DANIEL VEILLARD BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CON- IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CON- NECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. NECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. Except as contained in this notice, the name of the authors shall not Except as contained in this notice, the name of Daniel Veillard shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other deal- be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other deal- ings in this Software without prior written authorization from him. ings in this Software without prior written authorization from him. --------------------------------------------------------------------- --------------------------------------------------------------------- libyuv URL: http://code.google.com/p/libyuv/ Licence for libexslt --------------------------------------------------------------------- Copyright 2011 The LibYuv Project Authors. All rights reserved. 129 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without linux-syscall-support URL: http://code.google.com/p/linux-syscallsupport/ modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: // Copyright 2015 The Chromium Authors. All rights reserved. * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright // // Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. // modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright // met: // notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in // * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright the documentation and/or other materials provided with the // notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. distribution. // * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above * Neither the name of Google nor the names of its contributors may // copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software // in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the without specific prior written permission. // distribution. // * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS // contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT // this software without specific prior written permission. LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR // A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT // THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, // "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT // LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, // A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY // OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT // SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE // LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. // DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY 130 // THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT LZMA SDK // (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE URL: http://www.7-zip.org/sdk.html LZMA SDK is placed in the public domain. // OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. mesa URL: http://www.mesa3d.org/ LZ4 - Extremely fast compression URL: https://code.google.com/p/lz4/ The default Mesa license is as follows: LZ4 Library Copyright (C) 1999-2007 Brian Paul All Rights Reserved. Copyright (c) 2011-2014, Yann Collet All rights reserved. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, list of conditions and the following disclaimer. and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included other materials provided with the distribution. in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES BRIAN PAUL BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS Some parts of Mesa are copyrighted under the GNU LGPL. See the SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Mesa/docs/COPYRIGHT file for details. 131 * OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, modp base64 decoder * SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT URL: https://github.com/client9/stringencoders * LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, * MODP_B64 - High performance base64 encoder/decoder * DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY * Version 1.3 -- 17-Mar-2006 * http://modp.com/release/base64 * * THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT * Copyright (c) 2005, 2006 Nick Galbreath -- nickg [at] modp [dot] com * (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE * All rights reserved. * OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. * * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without Mojo * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are URL: https://github.com/domokit/mojo * met: // Copyright 2014 The Chromium Authors. All rights reserved. * // * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright // Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. // modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are * * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright // met: * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the // * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. // notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. * // * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above // * Neither the name of the modp.com nor the names of its // copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer * contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from // in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the * this software without specific prior written permission. // distribution. * // * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS // contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from * "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT // this software without specific prior written permission. * LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR // * A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT // THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS 132 // "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. // LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright // A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the // OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. // SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT // LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, 3. The names of its contributors may not be used to endorse or promote // DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY products derived from this software without specific prior written // THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT permission. // (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS // OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR mt19937ar URL: http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~mmat/MT/MT2002/emt19937ar.html A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, A C-program for MT19937, with initialization improved 2002/1/26. EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, Coded by Takuji Nishimura and Makoto Matsumoto. PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR Before using, initialize the state by using init_genrand(seed) PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF or init_by_array(init_key, key_length). LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS Copyright (C) 1997 - 2002, Makoto Matsumoto and Takuji Nishimura, SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. All rights reserved. Netscape Plugin Application Programming Interface (NPAPI) Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/mozillacentral/source/modules/plugin/base/public/ modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version 133 the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at -r1p0-00bet0.tgz http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ Use of this source code is governed by a BSD-style license that can be Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, found in the LICENSE file in the root of the source tree. All WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License contributing project authors may be found in the AUTHORS file in the for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the root of the source tree. The Original Code is mozilla.org code. The files were originally licensed by ARM Limited. The Initial Developer of the Original Code is The following files: Netscape Communications Corporation. Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 1998 * dl/api/omxtypes.h * dl/sp/api/omxSP.h the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. are licensed by Khronos: Contributor(s): Copyright © 2005-2008 The Khronos Group Inc. All Rights Reserved. Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or These materials are protected by copyright laws and contain material the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), proprietary to the Khronos Group, Inc. You may use these materials in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL are applicable instead for implementing Khronos specifications, without altering or removing of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only any trademark, copyright or other notice from the specification. under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to Khronos Group makes no, and expressly disclaims any, representations use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your or warranties, express or implied, regarding these materials, including, decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice without limitation, any implied warranties of merchantability or fitness and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete for a particular purpose or non-infringement of any intellectual property. the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under Khronos Group makes no, and expressly disclaims any, warranties, express the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. or implied, regarding the correctness, accuracy, completeness, timeliness, OpenMAX DL and reliability of these materials. URL: https://silver.arm.com/download/Software/Graphics/ OX000-BU-00010-r1p0-00bet0/OX000-BU-00010 Under no circumstances will the Khronos Group, or 134 any of its Promoters, THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS Contributors or Members or their respective partners, officers, directors, ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT employees, agents or representatives be liable for any damages, whether LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR direct, indirect, special or consequential damages for lost revenues, A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER lost profits, or otherwise, arising from or in connection with these OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, Khronos and OpenMAX are trademarks of the Khronos Group Inc. PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR opus PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF URL: http://git.xiph.org/?p=opus.git Copyright 2001-2011 Xiph.Org, Skype Limited, Octasic, LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING Jean-Marc Valin, Timothy B. Terriberry, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS CSIRO, Gregory Maxwell, Mark Borgerding, SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Erik de Castro Lopo Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without Opus is subject to the royalty-free patent licenses which are modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions specified at: https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1524/ are met: Microsoft Corporation: - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1914/ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Broadcom Corporation: https://datatracker.ietf.org/ipr/1526/ - Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright OTS (OpenType Sanitizer) notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the URL: https://github.com/khaledhosny/ots.git documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. PLY (Python Lex-Yacc) URL: http://www.dabeaz.com/ply/ply-3.4.tar.gz PLY (Python Lex-Yacc) Version 3.4 - Neither the name of Internet Society, IETF or IETF Trust, nor the names of specific contributors, may be used to endorse or promote Protocol Buffers URL: http://protobuf.googlecode.com/svn/trunk products derived from this software without specific prior written 135 Code generated by the Protocol Buffer compiler is owned by the owner URL: https://github.com/google/re2 of the input file used when generating it. This code is not sfntly URL: https://github.com/googlei18n/sfntly standalone and requires a support library to be linked with it. This Skia support library is itself covered by the above license. URL: https://skia.org/ Quick Color Management System ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- URL: https://github.com/jrmuizel/qcms/tree/v4 Some files under resources are under the following license: qcms Copyright (C) 2009 Mozilla Corporation Copyright (C) 1998-2007 Marti Maria Unlimited Commercial Use We try to make it clear that you may use all clipart from Openclipart even for unlimited commercial use. We believe that giving away our images is a great way to share with the world our talents and that will come back around in a better form. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation May I Use Openclipart for? the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, We put together a small chart of as many possibilities and questions we have heard from people asking how they may use Openclipart. If you have an additional question, please email love@openclipart.org. and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: All Clipart are Released into the Public Domain. Each artist at Openclipart releases all rights to the images they share at Openclipart. The reason is so that there is no friction in using and sharing images authors make available at this website so that each artist might also receive the same benefit in using other artists clipart totally for any possible reason. The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, SMHasher EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO URL: http://code.google.com/p/smhasher/ THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND Snappy: A fast compressor/decompressor LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION URL: http://google.github.io/snappy/ OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION sqlite WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. URL: http://sqlite.org/ The author disclaims copyright to this source code. In place of a legal notice, here is a blessing: re2 - an efficient, principled regular expression library 136 May you do good and not evil. GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. May you find forgiveness for yourself and forgive others. May you share freely, never taking more than you give. tcmalloc URL: http://gperftools.googlecode.com/ usrsctp URL: http://github.com/sctplab/usrsctp The USB ID Repository URL: http://www.linux-usb.org/usb-ids.html (Copied from the COPYRIGHT file of https://code.google.com/p/sctprefimpl/source/browse/trunk/COPYRIGHT) Copyright (c) 2012, Linux USB Project All rights reserved. ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Copyright (c) 2001, 2002 Cisco Systems, Inc. Copyright (c) 2002-12 Randall R. Stewart Copyright (c) 2002-12 Michael Tuexen o Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, All rights reserved. this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without o Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the are met: documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. o Neither the name of the Linux USB Project nor the names of its notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS 137 OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT --- LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY The above is the version of the MIT "Expat" License used by X.org: OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. http://cgit.freedesktop.org/xorg/xserver/tree/COPYIN G wayland URL: http://wayland.freedesktop.org/ wayland-protocols Copyright © 2008-2012 Kristian Høgsberg URL: http://wayland.freedesktop.org/ Copyright © 2010-2012 Intel Corporation Copyright © 2011 Benjamin Franzke Copyright © 2008-2013 Kristian Høgsberg Copyright © 2012 Collabora, Ltd. Copyright © 2010-2013 Intel Corporation Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), Copyright © 2013 Rafael Antognolli Copyright © 2013 Jasper St. Pierre Copyright © 2014 Jonas Ådahl Copyright © 2014 Jason Ekstrand Copyright © 2014-2015 Collabora, Ltd. to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation Copyright © 2015 Red Hat Inc. the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation The above copyright notice and this permission notice (including the next the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, paragraph) shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, The above copyright notice and this permission notice (including the next FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL paragraph) shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE 138 WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, provided with the FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL distribution. THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER * Neither the name of Google nor the names of its contributors may LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER without specific prior written permission. DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS --- "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT The above is the version of the MIT "Expat" License used by X.org: LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT http://cgit.freedesktop.org/xorg/xserver/tree/COPYIN G HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT Web Animations JS LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, URL: https://github.com/web-animations/webanimations-js DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY WebRTC THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT URL: http://www.webrtc.org (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE Copyright (c) 2011, The WebRTC project authors. All rights reserved. OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without x86inc modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: URL: http://git.videolan.org/?p=x264.git;a=blob;f=common/ x86/x86inc.asm * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright ;********************************************************* ******************** notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. ;* x86inc.asm * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ;* Copyright (C) 2005-2011 x264 project notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in ;* Authors: Loren Merritt ;********************************************************* ******************** ;* ;* Anton Mitrofanov the documentation and/or other materials 139 ;* Jason Garrett-Glaser zlib ;* URL: http://zlib.net/ ;* Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any /* zlib.h -- interface of the 'zlib' general purpose compression library ;* purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above version 1.2.4, March 14th, 2010 ;* copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. Copyright (C) 1995-2010 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark Adler ;* ;* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES ;* WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF This software is provided 'as-is', without any express or implied ;* MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR warranty. In no event will the authors be held liable for any damages arising from the use of this software. ;* ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES ;* WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose, ;* ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it ;* OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. freely, subject to the following restrictions: ;********************************************************* ******************** 1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote the original software. If you use this software ; This is a header file for the x264ASM assembly language, which uses in a product, an acknowledgment in the product documentation would be ; NASM/YASM syntax combined with a large number of macros to provide easy appreciated but is not required. ; abstraction between different calling conventions (x86_32, win64, linux64). 2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be ; It also has various other useful features to simplify writing the kind of misrepresented as being the original software. 3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution. ; DSP functions that are most often used in x264. ; Unlike the rest of x264, this file is available under an ISC license, as it Jean-loup Gailly Mark Adler ; has significant usefulness outside of x264 and we want it to be available ; to the largest audience possible. Of course, if you modify it for your own */ ; purposes to add a new feature, we strongly encourage contributing a patch url_parse ; as this feature might be useful for others as well. Send patches or ideas URL: http://mxr.mozilla.org/comm-central/source/m ozilla/netwerk/base/src/nsURLParsers.cpp ; to x264-devel@videolan.org . 140 Copyright 2007, Google Inc. ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ All rights reserved. The file url_parse.cc is based on nsURLParsers.cc from Mozilla. This file is Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without licensed separately as follows: modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its The Original Code is mozilla.org code. contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from The Initial Developer of the Original Code is this software without specific prior written permission. Netscape Communications Corporation. Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 1998 THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT Contributor(s): LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR Darin Fisher (original author) A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL are applicable instead DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. decision by deleting the provisions above and replace 141 them with the notice - Valgrind client API header, located at third_party/valgrind/valgrind.h and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete This is release under the BSD license. the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under These libraries have their own licenses; we recommend you read them, the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. as their terms may differ from the terms below. V8 JavaScript Engine Further license information can be found in LICENSE files located in URL: http://code.google.com/p/v8 sub-directories. This license applies to all parts of V8 that are not externally Copyright 2014, the V8 project authors. All rights reserved. maintained libraries. The externally maintained libraries used by V8 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without are: modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are - PCRE test suite, located in met: test/mjsunit/third_party/regexp-pcre/regexppcre.js. This is based on the test suite from PCRE-7.3, which is copyrighted by the University * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright of Cambridge and Google, Inc. The copyright notice and license notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. are embedded in regexp-pcre.js. * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following - Layout tests, located in test/mjsunit/third_party/object-keys. These are disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided based on layout tests from webkit.org which are copyrighted by with the distribution. Apple Computer, Inc. and released under a 3-clause BSD license. * Neither the name of Google Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived - Strongtalk assembler, the basis of the files assembler-arm-inl.h, from this software without specific prior written permission. assembler-arm.cc, assembler-arm.h, assembleria32-inl.h, assembler-ia32.cc, assembler-ia32.h, assemblerx64-inl.h, THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS assembler-x64.cc, assembler-x64.h, assemblermips-inl.h, "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT assembler-mips.cc, assembler-mips.h, assembler.cc and assembler.h. LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR This code is copyrighted by Sun Microsystems Inc. and released A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT under a 3-clause BSD license. OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY 142 DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, disclaimer in the SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, - Neither the name of Sun Microsystems or the names of contributors may DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT specific prior written permission. (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, fdlibm THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR URL: http://www.netlib.org/fdlibm/ PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR Copyright (C) 1993-2004 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved. CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, Developed at SunSoft, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business. PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software is freely granted, provided that this notice is preserved. PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF Strongtalk LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING URL: http://www.strongtalk.org/ NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS Copyright (c) 1994-2006 Sun Microsystems Inc. SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. All Rights Reserved. Extra bundled binaries Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without name modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are libcap URL: License https://sites.google.com/site/fullycapable/ met: Unless otherwise *explicitly* stated, the following text describes the - Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, licensed conditions under which the contents of this libcap release this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. may be used and distributed: - Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the above copyright ------------------------------------------------------------------------ notice, this list of conditions and the following 143 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms of libcap, with ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. or without modification, are permitted provided that the following ------------------------------------------------------------------------ conditions are met: notice, and this entire permission notice in its entirety, libnsspem URL: https://git.fedorahosted.org/cgit/nss-pem.git including the disclaimer of warranties. /* ***** BEGIN LICENSE BLOCK ***** copyright notices, this list of conditions, and the following * Version: MPL 1.1/GPL 2.0/LGPL 2.1 * disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided * The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version with the distribution. * 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with products derived from this software without their specific prior * the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at written permission. * http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ * ALTERNATIVELY, this product may be distributed under the terms of the * Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, GNU General Public License (v2.0 - see below), in which case the * WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License provisions of the GNU GPL are required INSTEAD OF the above restrictions. * for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the (This clause is necessary due to a potential conflict * License. between the GNU GPL and the restrictions contained in a BSD-style * * The Original Code is the Netscape security libraries. * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED * The Initial Developer of the Original Code is * Netscape Communications Corporation. WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF * Portions created by the Initial Developer are Copyright (C) 1994-2000 MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. * the Initial Developer. All Rights Reserved. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR(S) BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, * * Contributor(s): INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, * Rob Crittenden (rcritten@redhat.com) * BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS * Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND * either the GNU General Public License Version 2 or later (the "GPL"), or ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR * the GNU Lesser General Public License Version 2.1 or later (the "LGPL"), TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) 144 * in which case the provisions of the GPL or the LGPL are applicable instead a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the * of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including * under the terms of either the GPL or the LGPL, and not to allow others to without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, * use your version of this file under the terms of the MPL, indicate your distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to * decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to * and other provisions required by the GPL or the LGPL. If you do not delete the following conditions: * the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included * the terms of any one of the MPL, the GPL or the LGPL. in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. * ***** END LICENSE BLOCK ***** */ THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, Return to Documentation index. EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF © Opera TV AS 2015. Confidential information of Opera TV. MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY BSD LICENSE CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. _____________________________ This copy of the libpng notices is provided for your convenience. In case of any discrepancy between this copy and the notices in the file png.h that is included in the libpng distribution, the latter shall prevail. COPYRIGHT NOTICE, DISCLAIMER, and LICENSE: ______________________________ If you modify libpng you may insert additional notices immediately following MIT LICENSE this sentence. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining This code is released under the libpng license. 145 libpng versions 1.2.6, August 15, 2004, through 1.4.1, February 25, 2010, are Tom Lane Glenn Randers-Pehrson Copyright (c) 2004, 2006-2007 Glenn RandersPehrson, and are Willem van Schaik distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-1.2.5 libpng versions 0.89, June 1996, through 0.96, May 1997, are with the following individual added to the list of Contributing Authors Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 Andreas Dilger Distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-0.88, Cosmin Truta with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors: libpng versions 1.0.7, July 1, 2000, through 1.2.5 October 3, 2002, are John Bowler Copyright (c) 2000-2002 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are Kevin Bracey distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-1.0.6 Sam Bushell with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors Greg Roelofs Magnus Holmgren Tom Tanner Simon-Pierre Cadieux libpng versions 0.5, May 1995, through 0.88, January 1996, are Eric S. Raymond Gilles Vollant Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42, Inc. and with the following additions to the disclaimer: For the purposes of this copyright and license, "Contributing Authors" There is no warranty against interference with your enjoyment of the is defined as the following set of individuals: library or against infringement. There is no warranty that our Andreas Dilger efforts or the library will fulfill any of your particular purposes Dave Martindale Guy Eric Schalnat or needs. This library is provided with all faults, and the entire Paul Schmidt Tim Wegner risk of satisfactory quality, performance, accuracy, and effort is with the user. The PNG Reference Library is supplied "AS IS". The Contributing Authors libpng versions 0.97, January 1998, through 1.0.6, March 20, 2000, are and Group 42, Inc. disclaim all warranties, expressed or implied, Copyright (c) 1998, 1999 Glenn Randers-Pehrson, and are including, without limitation, the warranties of merchantability and of distributed according to the same disclaimer and license as libpng-0.96, fitness for any purpose. The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. with the following individuals added to the list of Contributing Authors: assume no liability for direct, indirect, incidental, special, exemplary, 146 or consequential damages, which may result from the use of the PNG This software is based in part on the work of the FreeType Team. Reference Library, even if advised of the possibility of such damage. ---------------------- Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify, and distribute this LICENSE source code, or portions hereof, for any purpose, without fee, subject ---------------------------- The FreeType Project to the following restrictions: 2006-Jan-27 be misrepresented as being the original source. Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by source or altered source distribution. David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg The Contributing Authors and Group 42, Inc. specifically permit, without Introduction fee, and encourage the use of this source code as a component to ============ supporting the PNG file format in commercial products. If you use this The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive packages; source code in a product, acknowledgment is not required but would be some of them may contain, in addition to the FreeType font engine, various tools and contributions which rely on, or relate to, the A "png_get_copyright" function is available, for convenient use in "about" FreeType Project. boxes and the like: This license applies to all files found in such packages, and printf("%s",png_get_copyright(NULL)); which do not fall under their own explicit license. The license Also, the PNG logo (in PNG format, of course) is supplied in the affects thus the FreeType font engine, the test programs, files "pngbar.png.jpg" and "pngbar.jpg (88x31) and "pngnow.png.jpg" (98x31). documentation and makefiles, at the very least. Libpng is OSI Certified Open Source Software. OSI Certified Open Source is a This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and IJG certification mark of the Open Source Initiative. (Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which all encourage inclusion and use of free software in commercial and freeware products Glenn Randers-Pehrson glennrp at users.sourceforge.net alike. As a consequence, its main points are that: February 25, 2010 o We don't promise that this software works. However, we will be _____________________________ interested in any kind of bug reports. (`as is' 147 distribution) `FreeType Project', and `FreeType archive' refer to the set of files originally o You can use this software for whatever you want, in parts or distributed by the authors (David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and full form, without having to pay us. (`royaltyfree' usage) Werner Lemberg) as the `FreeType Project', be they named as alpha, beta or final release. o You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in a program, you must acknowledge `You' refers to the licensee, or person using the project, where somewhere in your documentation that you have used the `using' is a generic term including compiling the project's source FreeType code. (`credits') code as well as linking it to form a `program' or `executable'. This program is referred to as `a program using the FreeType We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion of this engine'. software, with or without modifications, in commercial products. We disclaim all warranties covering The FreeType Project and This license applies to all files distributed in the original assume no liability related to The FreeType Project. FreeType Project, including all source code, binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form for a original, unmodified form as distributed in the original archive. credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with this license. We thus If you are unsure whether or not a particular file is covered by encourage you to use the following text: this license, you must contact us to verify this. """ The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000 by David Turner, Portions of this software are copyright ɠ The FreeType Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. All rights reserved except as Project (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved. """ specified below. Please replace with the value from the FreeType version you -------------THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED `AS IS' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY actually use. KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR Legal Terms =========== PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS -------------Throughout this license, the terms `package', BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE 148 USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT. -------------Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor you shall use ----------------- the name of the other for commercial, advertising, or promotional This license grants a worldwide, royaltyfree, perpetual and purposes without specific prior written permission. irrevocable right and license to use, execute, perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of, distribute and We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or more of the sublicense the FreeType Project (in both source and object code following phrases to refer to this software in your documentation forms) and derivative works thereof for any purpose; and to or advertising materials: `FreeType Project', `FreeType Engine', authorize others to exercise some or all of the rights granted `FreeType library', or `FreeType Distribution'. herein, subject to the following conditions: As you have not signed this license, you are not required to o Redistribution of source code must retain this license file accept it. However, as the FreeType Project is copyrighted (`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any additions, deletions or changes to material, only this license, or another one contracted with the the original files must be clearly indicated in accompanying authors, grants you the right to use, distribute, and modify it. documentation. The copyright notices of the unaltered, Therefore, by using, distributing, or modifying the FreeType original files must be preserved in all copies of source Project, you indicate that you understand and accept all the terms files. of this license. o Redistribution in binary form must provide a disclaimer that ----------There are two mailing lists related to FreeType: states that the software is based in part of the work of the o FreeType Team, in the distribution documentation. We also freetype@nongnu.org Discusses general use and applications of FreeType, as well as encourage you to put an URL to the FreeType web page in your future and wanted additions to the library and distribution. documentation, though this isn't mandatory. If you are looking for support, start in this list if you These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on haven't found anything to help you in the documentation. the FreeType Project, not just the unmodified files. If you use our work, you must acknowledge us. However, no fee need be paid o to us. 149 freetype-devel@nongnu.org Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, 1.5. "Executable" means Covered Code in any form other than Source specific licenses, porting, etc. Code. Our home page can be found at 1.6. "Initial Developer" means the individual or entity identified as the Initial Developer in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit http://www.freetype.org A. --- end of FTL.TXT --1.7. "Larger Work" means a work which combines Covered Code or _____________________________ portions thereof with code not governed by the terms of this License. MOZILLA PUBLIC LICENSE Version 1.1 1.8. "License" means this document. 1.8.1. "Licensable" means having the right to grant, to the maximum --------------- extent possible, whether at the time of the initial grant or 1.0.1. "Commercial Use" means distribution or otherwise making the subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights conveyed herein. Covered Code available to a third party. 1.9. "Modifications" means any addition to or deletion from the 1.1. "Contributor" means each entity that creates or contributes to substance or structure of either the Original Code or any previous the creation of Modifications. Modifications. When Covered Code is released as a series of files, a 1.2. "Contributor Version" means the combination of the Original Modification is: Code, prior Modifications used by a Contributor, and the Modifications A. Any addition to or deletion from the contents of a file made by that particular Contributor. containing Original Code or previous Modifications. 1.3. "Covered Code" means the Original Code or Modifications or the B. Any new file that contains any part of the Original Code or combination of the Original Code and Modifications, in each case previous Modifications. including portions thereof. 1.10. "Original Code" means Source Code of computer software code 1.4. "Electronic Distribution Mechanism" means a mechanism generally which is described in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A as accepted in the software development community for the electronic Original Code, and which, at the time of its release under this transfer of data. License is not already Covered Code governed 150 by this License. The Initial Developer hereby grants You a worldwide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license, subject to third party intellectual property 1.10.1. "Patent Claims" means any patent claim(s), now owned or claims: hereafter acquired, including without limitation, method, process, (a) under intellectual property rights (other than patent or and apparatus claims, in any patent Licensable by grantor. trademark) Licensable by Initial Developer to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the Original 1.11. "Source Code" means the preferred form of the Covered Code for Code (or portions thereof) with or without Modifications, and/or making modifications to it, including all modules it contains, plus as part of a Larger Work; and any associated interface definition files, scripts used to control compilation and installation of an Executable, or source code (b) under Patents Claims infringed by the making, using or differential comparisons against either the Original Code or another selling of Original Code, to make, have made, use, practice, well known, available Covered Code of the Contributor's choice. The sell, and offer for sale, and/or otherwise dispose of the Source Code can be in a compressed or archival form, provided the Original Code (or portions thereof). appropriate decompression or de-archiving software is widely available (c) the licenses granted in this Section 2.1(a) and (b) are for no charge. effective on the date Initial Developer first distributes 1.12. "You" (or "Your") means an individual or a legal entity Original Code under the terms of this License. exercising rights under, and complying with all of the terms of, this (d) Notwithstanding Section 2.1(b) above, no patent license is License or a future version of this License issued under Section 6.1. granted: 1) for code that You delete from the Original Code; 2) For legal entities, "You" includes any entity which controls, is separate from the Original Code; or 3) for infringements caused controlled by, or is under common control with You. For purposes of by: i) the modification of the Original Code or ii) the this definition, "control" means (a) the power, direct or indirect, combination of the Original Code with other software or devices. to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty percent 2.2. Contributor Grant. Subject to third party intellectual property claims, each Contributor (50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial ownership of such hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license entity. 2.1. The Initial Developer Grant. 151 (a) under intellectual property rights (other than patent or 4) under Patent Claims infringed by Covered Code in the absence of Modifications made by trademark) Licensable by Contributor, to use, reproduce, modify, that Contributor. display, perform, sublicense and distribute the Modifications 3.1. Application of License. created by such Contributor (or portions thereof) either on an The Modifications which You create or to which You contribute are unmodified basis, with other Modifications, as Covered Code governed by the terms of this License, including without limitation and/or as part of a Larger Work; and Section 2.2. The Source Code version of Covered Code may be (b) under Patent Claims infringed by the making, using, or distributed only under the terms of this License or a future version selling of Modifications made by that Contributor either alone of this License released under Section 6.1, and You must include a and/or in combination with its Contributor Version (or portions copy of this License with every copy of the Source Code You of such combination), to make, use, sell, offer for sale, have distribute. You may not offer or impose any terms on any Source Code made, and/or otherwise dispose of: 1) Modifications made by that version that alters or restricts the applicable version of this Contributor (or portions thereof); and 2) the combination of License or the recipients' rights hereunder. However, You may include Modifications made by that Contributor with its Contributor an additional document offering the additional rights described in Version (or portions of such combination). Section 3.5. 3.2. Availability of Source Code. (c) the licenses granted in Sections 2.2(a) and 2.2(b) are Any Modification which You create or to which You contribute must be effective on the date Contributor first makes Commercial Use of made available in Source Code form under the terms of this License the Covered Code. either on the same media as an Executable version or via an accepted (d) Notwithstanding Section 2.2(b) above, no patent license is Electronic Distribution Mechanism to anyone to whom you made an granted: 1) for any code that Contributor has deleted from the Executable version available; and if made available via Electronic Contributor Version; 2) separate from the Contributor Version; Distribution Mechanism, must remain available for at least twelve (12) 3) for infringements caused by: i) third party modifications of months after the date it initially became available, or at least six Contributor Version or ii) the combination of Modifications made (6) months after a subsequent version of that particular Modification by that Contributor with other software (except as part of the has been made available to such recipients. You are responsible for Contributor Version) or other devices; or ensuring that the Source Code version remains 152 available even if the obtained. Electronic Distribution Mechanism is maintained by a third party. (b) Contributor APIs. If Contributor's Modifications include an application programming 3.3. Description of Modifications. You must cause all Covered Code to which You contribute to contain a interface and Contributor has knowledge of patent licenses which file documenting the changes You made to create that Covered Code and are reasonably necessary to implement that API, Contributor must the date of any change. You must include a prominent statement that also include this information in the LEGAL file. the Modification is derived, directly or indirectly, from Original (c) Code provided by the Initial Developer and including the name of the Representations. Contributor represents that, except as disclosed pursuant to Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b) in any notice in an Section 3.4(a) above, Contributor believes that Contributor's Executable version or related documentation in which You describe the Modifications are Contributor's original creation(s) and/or origin or ownership of the Covered Code. Contributor has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by 3.4. Intellectual Property Matters this License. (a) Third Party Claims. If Contributor has knowledge that a license under a third party's 3.5. Required Notices. You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in each file of the Source intellectual property rights is required to exercise the rights Code. If it is not possible to put such notice in a particular Source granted by such Contributor under Sections 2.1 or 2.2, Code file due to its structure, then You must include such notice in a Contributor must include a text file with the Source Code location (such as a relevant directory) where a user would be likely distribution titled "LEGAL" which describes the claim and the to look for such a notice. If You created one or more Modification(s) party making the claim in sufficient detail that a recipient will You may add your name as a Contributor to the notice described in know whom to contact. If Contributor obtains such knowledge after Exhibit A. You must also duplicate this License in any documentation the Modification is made available as described in Section 3.2, for the Source Code where You describe recipients' rights or ownership Contributor shall promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies rights relating to Covered Code. You may choose to offer, and to Contributor makes available thereafter and shall take other steps charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or liability (such as notifying appropriate mailing lists or newsgroups) obligations to one or more recipients of Covered Code. However, You reasonably calculated to inform those who received the Covered may do so only on Your own behalf, and not on behalf of the Initial Code that new knowledge has been 153 Developer or any Contributor. You must make it absolutely clear than to indemnify the Initial Developer and every Contributor for any liability incurred by any such warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligation is the Initial Developer or such Contributor as a result of any such offered by You alone, and You hereby agree to indemnify the Initial terms You offer. Developer and every Contributor for any liability incurred by the 3.7. Larger Works. Initial Developer or such Contributor as a result of warranty, You may create a Larger Work by combining Covered Code with other code support, indemnity or liability terms You offer. not governed by the terms of this License and distribute the Larger 3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions. Work as a single product. In such a case, You must make sure the You may distribute Covered Code in Executable form only if the requirements of this License are fulfilled for the Covered Code. requirements of Section 3.1-3.5 have been met for that Covered Code, and if You include a notice stating that the Source Code version of If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the terms of this the Covered Code is available under the terms of this License, License with respect to some or all of the Covered Code due to including a description of how and where You have fulfilled the statute, judicial order, or regulation then You must: (a) comply with obligations of Section 3.2. The notice must be conspicuously included the terms of this License to the maximum extent possible; and (b) in any notice in an Executable version, related documentation or describe the limitations and the code they affect. Such description collateral in which You describe recipients' rights relating to the must be included in the LEGAL file described in Section 3.4 and must Covered Code. You may distribute the Executable version of Covered be included with all distributions of the Source Code. Except to the Code or ownership rights under a license of Your choice, which may extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such description must be contain terms different from this License, provided that You are in sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able to compliance with the terms of this License and that the license for the understand it. Executable version does not attempt to limit or alter the recipient's This License applies to code to which the Initial Developer has rights in the Source Code version from the rights set forth in this attached the notice in Exhibit A and to related Covered Code. License. If You distribute the Executable version under a different 6.1. New Versions. license You must make it absolutely clear that any terms which differ Netscape Communications Corporation ("Netscape") may publish revised from this License are offered by You alone, not by the Initial and/or new versions of the License from time to time. Each version Developer or any Contributor. You hereby agree 154 will be given a distinguishing version number. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE COVERED CODE IS WITH YOU. SHOULD ANY COVERED CODE PROVE DEFECTIVE IN ANY RESPECT, 6.2. Effect of New Versions. Once Covered Code has been published under a particular version of the YOU (NOT THE INITIAL DEVELOPER OR ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR) ASSUME THE License, You may always continue to use it under the terms of that COST OF ANY NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. THIS DISCLAIMER version. You may also choose to use such Covered Code under the terms OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS LICENSE. NO USE OF of any subsequent version of the License published by Netscape. No one ANY COVERED CODE IS AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER. other than Netscape has the right to modify the terms applicable to 8.1. This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate Covered Code created under this License. automatically if You fail to comply with terms herein and fail to cure 6.3. Derivative Works. If You create or use a modified version of this License (which you may such breach within 30 days of becoming aware of the breach. All only do in order to apply it to code which is not already Covered Code sublicenses to the Covered Code which are properly granted shall governed by this License), You must (a) rename Your license so that survive any termination of this License. Provisions which, by their the phrases "Mozilla", "MOZILLAPL", "MOZPL", "Netscape", nature, must remain in effect beyond the termination of this License "MPL", "NPL" or any confusingly similar phrase do not appear in your shall survive. license (except to note that your license differs from this License) 8.2. If You initiate litigation by asserting a patent infringement and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your version of the license claim (excluding declatory judgment actions) against Initial Developer contains terms which differ from the Mozilla Public License and or a Contributor (the Initial Developer or Contributor against whom Netscape Public License. (Filling in the name of the Initial You file such action is referred to as "Participant") alleging that: Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the notice described in (a) such Participant's Contributor Version directly or indirectly Exhibit A shall not of themselves be deemed to be modifications of infringes any patent, then any and all rights granted by such this License.) Participant to You under Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 of this License COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, shall, upon 60 days notice from Participant terminate prospectively, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, unless if within 60 days after receipt of notice You either: (i) WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES THAT THE COVERED CODE IS FREE OF agree in writing to pay Participant a mutually agreeable reasonable DEFECTS, MERCHANTABLE, FIT FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGING. 155 royalty for Your past and future use of Modifications made by such which have been validly granted by You or any distributor hereunder Participant, or (ii) withdraw Your litigation claim with respect to prior to termination shall survive termination. the Contributor Version against such Participant. If within 60 days UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER TORT of notice, a reasonable royalty and payment arrangement are not (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE, SHALL YOU, THE INITIAL mutually agreed upon in writing by the parties or the litigation claim DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY DISTRIBUTOR OF COVERED CODE, is not withdrawn, the rights granted by Participant to You under OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON FOR Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 automatically terminate at the expiration of ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY the 60 day notice period specified above. CHARACTER INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL, (b) any software, hardware, or device, other than such Participant's WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER Contributor Version, directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF SUCH PARTY SHALL HAVE BEEN any rights granted to You by such Participant under Sections 2.1(b) INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. THIS LIMITATION OF and 2.2(b) are revoked effective as of the date You first made, used, LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY sold, distributed, or had made, Modifications made by that RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY'S NEGLIGENCE TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW Participant. PROHIBITS SUCH LIMITATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO 8.3. If You assert a patent infringement claim against Participant THIS EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. alleging that such Participant's Contributor Version directly or indirectly infringes any patent where such claim is resolved (such as The Covered Code is a "commercial item," as that term is defined in by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of patent 48 C.F.R. 2.101 (Oct. 1995), consisting of "commercial computer infringement litigation, then the reasonable value of the licenses software" and "commercial computer software documentation," as such granted by such Participant under Sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 (Sept. 1995). Consistent with 48 into account in determining the amount or value of any payment or C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4 (June 1995), license. all U.S. Government End Users acquire Covered Code with only those 8.4. In the event of termination under Sections 8.1 or 8.2 above, rights set forth herein. all end user license agreements (excluding distributors and resellers) This License represents the complete agreement 156 concerning subject Initial Developer may designate portions of the Covered Code as matter hereof. If any provision of this License is held to be "Multiple-Licensed". "Multiple-Licensed" means that the Initial unenforceable, such provision shall be reformed only to the extent Developer permits you to utilize portions of the Covered Code under necessary to make it enforceable. This License shall be governed by Your choice of the NPL or the alternative licenses, if any, specified California law provisions (except to the extent applicable law, if by the Initial Developer in the file described in Exhibit A. any, provides otherwise), excluding its conflictof-law provisions. With respect to disputes in which at least one party is a citizen of, EXHIBIT A -Mozilla Public License. or an entity chartered or registered to do business in the United ``The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License States of America, any litigation relating to this License shall be Version 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in subject to the jurisdiction of the Federal Courts of the Northern compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at District of California, with venue lying in Santa Clara County, http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ California, with the losing party responsible for costs, including Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees and basis, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the expenses. The application of the United Nations Convention on License for the specific language governing rights and limitations Contracts for the International Sale of Goods is expressly excluded. under the License. Any law or regulation which provides that the language of a contract The Original Code is ______________________________________. shall be construed against the drafter shall not apply to this License. The Initial Developer of the Original Code is ________________________. Portions created by ______________________ are Copyright (C) ______ As between Initial Developer and the Contributors, each party is _______________________. All Rights Reserved. responsible for claims and damages arising, directly or indirectly, out of its utilization of rights under this License and You agree to Contributor(s): ______________________________________. work with Initial Developer and Contributors to distribute such Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing herein is intended or of the _____ license (the "[___] License"), in which case the shall be deemed to constitute any admission of liability. provisions of [______] License are applicable instead of those 157 above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only under the terms of the [____] License and not to allow others to use your version of this file under the MPL, indicate your decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice and other provisions required by the [___] License. If you do not delete the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under either the MPL or the [___] License." [NOTE: The text of this Exhibit A may differ slightly from the text of the notices in the Source Code files of the Original Code. You should use the text of this Exhibit A rather than the text found in the Original Code Source Code for Your Modifications.] 158 22 Specifications 22.1 Please inform yourself about the local separate collection system for electrical and electronic products. Environmental Please act according to your local rules and do not dispose of your old products with your normal household waste. Correct disposal of your old product helps to prevent potential negative consequences for the environment and human health. European Energy Label The European Energy Label informs you on the energy efficiency class of this product. The greener the energy efficiency class of this product is, the lower the energy it consumes. On the label, you can find the energy efficiency class, the average power consumption of this product in use and the average energy consumption for 1 year. You can also find the power consumption values for this product on the Philips website for your country at www.philips.com/TV Your product contains batteries covered by the European Directive 2006/66/EC, which cannot be disposed with normal household waste. Please find out for yourself about the local rules on separate collection of batteries because correct disposal will help to prevent negative consequences for the environment and human health. Product Fiche 55POS9002 • Energy Efficiency Class : B • Visible Screen Size : 139 cm / 55 inch • On Mode Power Consumption (W) : 150 W • Annual Energy Consumption (kWh) * : 219 kWh • Standby Power Consumption (W) ** : 0.30 W • Display Resolution (Pixels) : 3840 x 2160p 22.2 Power Product specifications are subject to change without notice. For more specification details of this product, see www.philips.com/support * Energy consumption kWh per year, based on the power consumption of the television operating 4 hours per day for 365 days. The actual energy consumption depends on how the television is used. ** When the TV is turned off with the remote control and no function is active. Power • Mains power : AC 220-240V +/-10% • Ambient temperature : 5°C to 35°C • Power saving features : Eco mode, Picture mute (for radio), Auto switch-off timer, Eco settings menu. End of Use For power consumption information, see chapter Product Fiche. The power rating stated on the product typeplate is the power consumption for this product during normal household use (IEC 62087 Ed.2). The maximum power rating, stated between brackets, is used for electrical safety (IEC 60065 Ed. 7.2). Disposal of your old product and batteries Your product is designed and manufactured with high quality materials and components, which can be recycled and reused. 22.3 Operating System When this crossed-out wheeled bin symbol is attached to a product it means that the product is covered by the European Directive 2012/19/EU. Android OS : Android Nougat 7 159 22.4 22.7 Reception Connectivity • Aerial input : 75 ohm coaxial (IEC75) • Tuner bands : Hyperband, S-Channel, UHF, VHF • DVB : DVB-T2, DVB-C (cable) QAM • Analogue video playback : SECAM, PAL • Digital video playback : MPEG2 SD/HD (ISO/IEC 13818-2), MPEG4 SD/HD (ISO/IEC 14496-10), HEVC* • Digital audio playback (ISO/IEC 13818-3) • Satellite aerial input : 75 ohm F-type • Input frequency range : 950 to 2150MHz • Input level range : 25 to 65 dBm • DVB-S/S2 QPSK, symbol rate 2 to 45M symbols, SCPC and MCPC • LNB : DiSEqC 1.0, 1 to 4 LNBs supported, Polarity selection 14/18V, Band selection 22kHz, Tone burst mode, LNB current 300mA max TV Side • Common Interface slot: CI+/CAM • USB 1 - USB 2.0 • USB 2 - USB 3.0 • Headphones - Stereo mini-jack 3.5mm • HDMI 1 in - ARC - MHL - Ultra HD - HDR • HDMI 2 in - ARC - Ultra HD - HDR * Only for DVB-T2, DVB-S2 TV Bottom • Audio out - Optical Toslink • Network LAN - RJ45 • YPbPr, L/R • HDMI 4 in - ARC • HDMI 3 in - ARC • Antenna (75 ohm) • YPbPr, L/R • Satellite tuner 22.5 22.8 Display Type Sound Diagonal screen size • 139 cm / 55 inch • Output power (RMS) : 30W • Dolby Audio • DTS Premium Sound ™ Display resolution • 3840 x 2160 22.9 Multimedia 22.6 Display Input Resolution Connections • USB 2.0 / USB 3.0 • Ethernet LAN RJ-45 • Wi-Fi 802.11a/b/g/n/ac (built-in) • BT2.1 with EDR & BT4.0 with BLE (* Your TV doesn't support Bluetooth subwoofer and Bluetooth speakers) Video formats Resolution — Refresh rate • 480i - 60 Hz • 480p - 60 Hz • 576i - 50 Hz • 576p - 50 Hz • 720p - 50 Hz, 60 Hz • 1080i - 50 Hz, 60 Hz • 1080p - 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz • 2160p - 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz, 50 Hz, 60 Hz Supported USB file systems • FAT 16, FAT 32, NTFS Playback formats • Video Codecs : AVI, MKV, H264/MPEG-4 AVC, MPEG-1, MPEG-2, MPEG-4, WMV9/VC1, HEVC • Audio Codecs : AAC, MP3, WAV, WMA (v2 up to v9.2), WMA-PRO (v9 and v10) • Subtitles : – Formats : SRT, SUB, TXT, SMI – Character encodings : UTF-8, Central Europe and Eastern Europe (Windows-1250), Cyrillic (Windows-1251), Greek (Windows-1253), Turkish (Windows-1254), Western Europe (Windows-1252) • Image Codecs : JPEG • Limitations : – Maximum supported total bit rate for a media file is 30Mbps. – Maximum supported video bit rate for a media file Computer formats Resolutions (amongst others) • 640 x 480p - 60 Hz • 800 x 600p - 60 Hz • 1024 x 768p - 60 Hz • 1280 x 768p - 60 Hz • 1360 x 765p - 60 Hz • 1360 x 768p - 60 Hz • 1280 x 1024p - 60 Hz • 1920 x 1080p - 60 Hz • 3840 x 2160p - 24 Hz, 25 Hz, 30 Hz, 50 Hz, 60 Hz 160 is 20Mbps. – MPEG-4 AVC (H.264) is supported up to High Profile @ L5.1. – H.265 (HEVC) is supported upto Main / Main 10 Profile up to Level 5.1 – VC-1 is supported up to Advanced Profile @ L3. Supported media server software (DMS) • You can use any DLNA V1.5 certified media server software (DMS class). • You can use the Philips TV Remote app (iOS and Android) on mobile devices. Performance may vary, depending on the capabilities of the mobile device and the software used. 161 23 Switch On and Remote Control Help and Support The TV does not switch on • Disconnect the power cable from the power outlet. Wait for one minute then reconnect it. • Make sure that the power cable is securely connected. 23.1 Register your TV Creaking sound at startup or switch off Register your TV and enjoy a range of benefits including full support (including downloads), privileged access to information about new products, exclusive offers and discounts, the chance to win prizes and even participate in special surveys about new releases. When you are switching the TV on, off or to standby, you hear a creaking sound from the TV chassis. The creaking sound is due to the normal expansion and contraction of the TV as it cools and warms up. This does not affect performance. Go to www.philips.com/welcome TV does not respond to the remote control The TV requires some time to start up. During this time, the TV does not respond to the remote control or TV controls. This is normal behaviour. If the TV continues to be unresponsive to the remote control, you can check if the remote control is working by means of a mobile phone camera. Put the phone in camera mode and point the remote control to the camera lens. If you press any key on the remote control and you notice the infra red LED flicker through the camera, the remote control is working. The TV needs to be checked. If you do not notice the flickering, the remote control might be broken or its batteries are low. This method of checking the remote control is not possible with remote controls which are wirelessly paired with the TV. 23.2 Using Help This TV offers help on screen . Open Help Press the key (blue) to open Help immediately. Help will open on the chapter that is most relevant to what you are doing or what is selected on TV. To look up topics alphabetically, press the colour key Keywords . To read the Help as a book, select Book. You can also open Help in the Home menu or TV menu. The TV goes back to standby after showing the Before you execute the Help instructions, close Help. To close Help, press the colour key Close . Philips startup screen When the TV is in standby, a Philips startup screen is displayed, then the TV returns to standby mode. This is normal behaviour. When the TV is disconnected and reconnected to the power supply, the startup screen is displayed at the next startup. To switch on the TV from standby, press on the remote control or on the TV. For some activities, like Text (Teletext), the colour keys have specific functions and cannot open Help. TV Help on your tablet, smartphone or computer To carry out extended sequences of instructions more easily, you can download the TV Help in PDF format to read on your smartphone, tablet or computer. Alternatively, you can print the relevant Help page from your computer. To download the Help (user manual) go to www.philips.com/support The standby light keeps on blinking Disconnect the power cable from the power outlet. Wait 5 minutes before you reconnect the power cable. If the blinking reoccurs, contact Philips TV Consumer Care. 23.3 Troubleshooting Channels No digital channels found during the installation See the technical specifications to make sure that your TV supports DVB-T or DVB-C in your country. Make sure that all cables are properly connected and that the correct network is selected. Previously installed channels are not in the channel 162 • Make sure that all cables are properly connected. • Make sure that the volume is not muted or set to zero. • Make sure that the TV audio output is connected to the audio input on the Home Theatre System. Sound should be heard from the HTS speakers. • Some devices may require you to manually enable HDMI audio output. If HDMI audio is already enabled, but you still do not hear audio, try changing the digital audio format of the device to PCM (Pulse Code Modulation). Refer to the documentation accompanying your device for instructions. list Make sure that the correct channel list is selected. Picture No picture / distorted picture • Make sure that the antenna is properly connected to the TV. • Make sure that the correct device is selected as the display source. • Make sure that the external device or source is properly connected. Sound but no picture • Make sure that the picture settings are set correctly. HDMI and USB Poor antenna reception • Make sure that the antenna is properly connected to the TV. • Loud speakers, unearthed audio devices, neon lights, high buildings and other large objects can influence reception quality. If possible, try to improve the reception quality by changing the antenna direction or moving devices away from the TV. • If reception on only one channel is poor, fine-tune this channel with Manual Installation. HDMI • Note that HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection) support can delay the time taken for a TV to display content from an HDMI device. • If the TV does not recognise the HDMI device and no picture is displayed, switch the source from one device to another and back again. • If the picture and sound of a device connected to HDMI 3 or HDMI 4 is distorted, connect the device to HDMI 1 or HDMI 2 on this TV. • If the picture and sound of a device connected with HDMI is distorted, check if a different HDMI Ultra HD setting can solve this problem. In Help, press the colour key Keywords and look up HDMI Ultra HD. • If there are intermittent sound disruptions, make sure that output settings from the HDMI device are correct. • If you use an HDMI-to-DVI adapter or HDMI-to-DVI cable, make sure that an additional audio cable is connected to AUDIO IN (mini-jack only), if available. Poor picture from a device • Make sure that the device is connected properly. • Make sure that the picture settings are set correctly. Picture settings change after a while Make sure that Location is set to Home . You can change and save settings in this mode. A commercial banner appears Make sure that Location is set to Home. Picture does not fit the screen HDMI EasyLink does not work • Make sure that your HDMI devices are HDMI-CEC compatible. EasyLink features only work with devices that are HDMI-CEC compatible. Change to a different picture format. Picture position is incorrect Picture signals from some devices may not fit the screen correctly. Check the signal output of the connected device. No volume icon shown • When an HDMI-CEC audio device is connected and you use the TV Remote Control to adjust the volume level from the device, this behaviour is normal. Photos, videos and music from a USB device do not Computer picture is not stable Make sure that your PC uses the supported resolution and refresh rate. show • Make sure that the USB storage device is set to Mass Storage Class compliant, as described in the storage device's documentation. • Make sure that the USB storage device is compatible with the TV. • Make sure that the audio and picture file formats are supported by the TV. Sound No sound or poor sound quality If no audio signal is detected, the TV automatically switches the audio output off — this does not indicate malfunction. Choppy playback of USB files • The transfer performance of the USB storage device may limit the data transfer rate to the TV which causes poor playback. • Make sure that the sound settings are correctly set. 163 23.4 Online Help To solve any Philips TV related problem, you can consult our online support. You can select your language and enter your product model number. Go to www.philips.com/support . On the support site you can find your country's telephone number to contact us as well as answers to frequently asked questions (FAQs). In some countries, you can chat with one of our collaborators and ask your question directly or send a question by email. You can download new TV software or the manual to read on your computer. 23.5 Support and Repair For support and repair, call the Consumer Care hotline in your country. Our service engineers will take care of a repair, if necessary. Find the telephone number in the printed documentation that came with the TV. Or consult our website www.philips.com/support and select your country if needed. TV model number and serial number You might be asked to provide the TV product model number and serial number. Find these numbers on the packaging label or on the type label on the back or bottom of the TV. Warning Do not attemp to repair the TV yourself. This may cause severe injury, irrepairable damage to your TV or void your warranty. 164 ensure that the power voltage matches the value printed on the back of the TV. Never connect the TV to the power outlet if the voltage is different. 24 Safety and Care 24.1 Risk of Injury to Children Safety Follow these precautions to prevent the TV from toppling over and causing injury to children: Important • Never place the TV on a surface covered by a cloth or other material that can be pulled away. • Ensure that no part of the TV hangs over the edge of the mounting surface. • Never place the TV on tall furniture, such as a bookcase, without anchoring both the furniture and TV to the wall or a suitable support. • Teach children about the dangers of climbing on furniture to reach the TV. Read and understand all safety instructions before you use the TV. If damage is caused by failure to follow instructions, the warranty does not apply. Risk of Electric Shock or Fire • Never expose the TV to rain or water. Never place liquid containers, such as vases, near the TV. If liquids are spilt on or into the TV, disconnect the TV from the power outlet immediately. Contact Philips TV Consumer Care to have the TV checked before use. • Never expose the TV, remote control or batteries to excessive heat. Never place them near burning candles, naked flames or other heat sources, including direct sunlight. • Never insert objects into the ventilation slots or other openings on the TV. • Never place heavy objects on the power cord. • Avoid force coming onto power plugs. Loose power plugs can cause arcing or fire. Ensure that no strain is exerted on the power cord when you swivel the TV screen. • To disconnect the TV from the mains power, the power plug of the TV must be disconnected. When disconnecting the power, always pull the power plug, never the cord. Ensure that you have full access to the power plug, power cord and outlet socket at all times. Risk of swallowing batteries ! The remote control may contain coin-type batteries which can easily be swallowed by small children. Keep these batteries out of reach of children at all times. Risk of Overheating Never install the TV in a confined space. Always leave a space of at least 10 cm or 4 inches around the TV for ventilation. Ensure curtains or other objects never cover the ventilation slots on the TV. Lightning Storms Disconnect the TV from the power outlet and antenna before lightning storms. During lightning storms, never touch any part of the TV, power cord or antenna cable. Risk of Injury or Damage to the TV Risk of Hearing Damage • Two people are required to lift and carry a TV that weighs more than 25 kg or 55 lbs. • If you mount the TV on a stand, only use the supplied stand. Secure the stand to the TV tightly. Place the TV on a flat, level surface that can support the weight of the TV and the stand. • When wall mounted, ensure that the wall mount can safely bear the weight of the TV set. TP Vision bears no responsibility for improper wall mounting that results in accident, injury or damage. • Parts of this product are made of glass. Handle with care to avoid injury or damage. Avoid using earphones or headphones at high volumes or for prolonged periods of time. Low Temperatures If the TV is transported in temperatures below 5°C or 41°F, unpack the TV and wait until the TV temperature reaches room temperature before connecting the TV to the power outlet. Risk of damage to the TV ! Before you connect the TV to the power outlet, 165 Humidity In rare occasions, depending on temperature and humidity, minor condensation can occur on the inside of the TV glass front (on some models). To prevent this, do not expose the TV to direct sunlight, heat or extreme humidity. If condensation occurs, it will disappear spontaneously while the TV is playing for a few hours. The condensation moisture will not harm the TV or cause malfunction. 24.2 Screen Care • Never touch, push, rub or strike the screen with any object. • Unplug the TV before cleaning. • Clean the TV and frame with a soft damp cloth and wipe gently. Avoid touching the Ambilight LEDs on the backside of the TV. Never use substances such as alcohol, chemicals or household cleaners on the TV. • To avoid deformations and colour fading, wipe off water drops as quickly as possible. • Avoid stationary images as much as possible. Stationary images are images that remain onscreen for extended periods of time. Stationary images include onscreen menus, black bars, time displays, etc. If you must use stationary images, reduce screen contrast and brightness to avoid screen damage. 166 black dots or bright points of light (red, green or blue) may appear constantly on the screen. This is a structural property of the display (within common industry standards) and is not a malfunction. 25 Terms of Use 25.1 CE compliance Hereby, TP Vision Europe B.V. declares that this television is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directives 1999/5/EC RTTE), 2004/108/EC (EMC), 2006/95/ EC (Low Voltage), 2009/125/EC (Energy Labelling) and 2011/65/EC (RoHS). From June 2016 onwards the following Directives are valid 2014/53/EU (RED), 2009/125/EC (Eco Design), 2010/30/ EU (Energy Labelling) and 2011/65/EC (RoHS). Terms of Use - TV 2017 © TP Vision Europe B.V. All rights reserved. This product was brought to the market by TP Vision Europe B.V. or one of its affiliates, hereinafter referred to as TP Vision, which is the manufacturer of the product. TP Vision is the warrantor in relation to the TV with which this booklet was packaged. Philips and the Philips Shield Emblem are registered trademarks of Koninklijke Philips N.V. Compliance with EMF TP Vision manufactures and sells many products targeted at consumers which, like any electronic apparatus, in general have the ability to emit and receive electromagnetic signals. One of TP Vision’s leading business principles is to take all necessary health and safety measures for our products, to comply with all applicable legal requirements and to stay well within the Electro Magnetic Field (EMF) standards applicable at the time of producing the products. Specifications are subject to change without notice. Trademarks are the property of Koninklijke Philips N.V or their respective owners. TP Vision reserves the right to change products at any time without being obliged to adjust earlier supplies accordingly. The written material packaged with the TV and the manual stored in the memory of the TV or downloaded from the Philips website www.philips.com/support are believed to be adequate for the intended use of the system. TP Vision is committed to developing, producing and marketing products that cause no adverse health effects. TP Vision confirms that, as long as its products are handled properly for their intended use, they are safe to use according to scientific evidence available today. TP Vision plays an active role in the development of international EMF and safety standards, enabling TP Vision to anticipate further developments in standardisation for early integration in its products. The material in this manual is believed adequate for the intended use of the system. If the product, or its individual modules or procedures, are used for purposes other than those specified herein, confirmation of their validity and suitability must be obtained. TP Vision warrants that the material itself does not infringe any United States patents. No further warranty is expressed or implied. TP Vision cannot be held responsible neither for any errors in the content of this document nor for any problems as a result of the content in this document. Errors reported to Philips will be adapted and published on the Philips support website as soon as possible. 25.2 Terms of Use - Smart TV Terms of warranty - Risk of injury, damage to TV or void of warranty! Never attempt to repair the TV yourself. Use the TV and accessories only as intended by the manufacturer. The caution sign printed on the back of the TV indicates risk of electric shock. Never remove the TV cover. Always contact Philips TV Customer Care for service or repairs. Find the telephone number in the printed documentation that came with the TV. Or consult our website www.philips.com/support and select your country if needed. Any operation expressly prohibited in this manual, or any adjustments and assembly procedures not recommended or authorised in this manual, shall void the warranty. You can see the terms of use, privacy policy, and also set privacy settings of your Smart TV. To open the terms of use of Smart TV page… 1 - Press HOME to open the Home menu. 2 - Select Apps to open Apps. Pixel characteristics This TV product has a high number of colour pixels. Although it has effective pixels of 99.999% or more, 167 26 26.4 Copyrights Dolby Audio 26.1 Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Dolby Audio, and the double-D symbol are MHL trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. MHL MHL, Mobile High-Definition Link and the MHL Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of the MHL, LLC. 26.5 DTS Premium Sound ™ DTS Premium Sound ™ For DTS patents, see http://patents.dts.com. Manufactured under license from DTS Licensing Limited. DTS, the Symbol, & DTS and the Symbol together are registered trademarks, and DTS Premium Sound is a trademark of DTS, Inc. © DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. 26.2 Ultra HD Ultra HD The DIGITALEUROPE UHD Display Logo is a trademark of DIGITALEUROPE. 26.6 26.3 Wi-Fi Alliance HDMI Wi-Fi HDMI Wi-Fi®, the Wi-Fi CERTIFIED logo, the Wi-Fi logo are registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance. The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries. 26.7 Kensington Kensington (If applicable) Kensington and Micro Saver are registered US trademarks of ACCO World Corporation with issued 168 registrations and pending applications in other countries throughout the world. 26.8 Other Trademarks All other registered and unregistered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. 169 27 Disclaimer regarding services and/or software offered by third parties Services and/or software offered by third parties may be changed, suspended, or terminated without prior notice. TP Vision does not bear any responsibility in these sorts of situations. 170 Index A Age Rating 11 Ambilight+hue, configuration 50 Ambilight+hue, Immersion 50 Ambilight+hue, on or off 50 Ambilight, Settings 49 Android Settings 34 Antenna connection 4 Antenna, Manual Installation 21 APP lock 37 Apps 35 Audio Language 12 Audio Language, Primary 12 Audio Language, Secondary 12 Auto Volume Levelling 48 Automatic Channel Update 19 B Contrast, Contrast Mode 45 Contrast, Perfect Contrast 46 D Digital Text 14 Disposal of TV or batteries 159 DVB (Digital Video Broadcast) 20 DVD player 26 E EasyLink HDMI CEC 51 Eco Settings 51 End of use 159 European Ecolabel 159 F Frequency Scan 20 Frequency Step Size 20 Blu-ray Disc player, connect 26 Bluetooth, Pairing 27 Bluetooth, Remove device 27 Bluetooth, Select device 27 G C Hard of hearing 54 HDMI MHL 24 HDMI Ultra HD 52 HDMI, ARC 24 Headphones Volume 49 Headphones, connect 27 Home Menu 68 Home Theatre System, problems 26 Hue Bridge 50 Hue Bulbs 50 Cable, Manual Installation 21 CAM, Conditional Access Module 25 Camcorder, connect 30 Channel 10 Channel List 10 Channel List Copy 21 Channel List Copy, copy 21 Channel List Copy, current version 22 Channel List Copy, upload 22 Channel List, about 10 Channel List, filter 10 Channel List, open 10 Channel List, search 10 Channel logos 53 Channel Update Message 19 Channel, age rating 11 Channel, Antenna Installation 19 Channel, Automatic Channel Update 19 Channel, Cable Installation 19 Channel, Manual channel update 19 Channel, Options 11 Channel, Reinstall 19 Channel, switch to a channel 11 Channel, TV guide 60 Child Lock 54 Child Lock, App Lock 55 CI+ 25 Clear Dialogue 48 Clear Image Residual 47 Colour, colour control 45 Colour, Colour enhancement 44 Common Interface Slot 25 Computer, connect 30 Computer, setting 44 Connect, USB Flash Drive 30 Connectivity Guide 24 Consumer Care 164 Contact Philips 164 Game Console, connect 28 Google Play Store 36 H I Internet memory, clear 33 K Keys on TV 9 M Media 56 Media files, from a computer or NAS 56 Media files, from a USB drive 56 MPEG Artefact Reduction 46 N Network Frequency 20 Network Frequency Mode 20 Network Installation 32 Network, connect 32 Network, settings 33 Network, Wired 33 Network, WPS with PIN code 32 Now on TV 66 O On and Off 9 Online support 164 Open Source software 71 Options on a Channel 11 P 171 Parental Rating 11 Partially sighted 54 Pause TV 62 Photo camera, connect 30 Photos, Videos and Music 56 Picture Style 44 Picture, picture format 47 Picture, quick settings 47 Power connection 4 Power consumption check 51 Problems, Channels 162 Problems, HDMI Connection 163 Problems, Picture 163 Problems, Remote control 162 Problems, Sound 163 Problems, USB Connection 163 Product Fiche 159 Programmes, Recommendations 66 V Video on Demand 67 Viewing distance 4 W Watch TV 11 Wi-Fi 32 Wired Network 33 Wireless Network 32 R Radio stations 10 Reception Quality 20 Recording 62 Recording, TV Guide data 60 Register your product 162 Reinstall TV 19 Repair 164 S Safety Instructions 165 Screen care 166 Sharpness, MPEG Artefact Reduction 46 Smart Card, CAM 25 Software, Update 70 Sound Style 48 Sound, Auto Volume Levelling 48 Sound, Clear Dialogue 48 Sound, Headphones Volume 49 Standby 9 Subtitle 12 Subtitle Language 12 Subtitle Language, Primary 12 Subtitle Language, Secondary 12 Support, online 164 Switching On 9 T Teletext 14 Terms of Use 167 Test Reception 20 Text 14 Text language, Primary 15 Text language, Secondary 15 Troubleshooting 162 TV Guide 60 TV Guide, data and information 60 TV Guide, Reminder 60 TV Installation 19 TV network name 33 TV on Demand 66 TV placement 4 U Universal Access 54 USB Hard Drive, disk space 28 USB Hard Drive, Installation 28 USB Keyboard 29 USB Keyboard, connect 29 172 Powered by TCPDF (www.tcpdf.org) 173
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf Linearized : No Warning : Duplicate 'PageMode' entry in dictionary (ignored) PDF Version : 1.7 Page Count : 173 Page Layout : SinglePage Page Mode : UseNone XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.2.1-c043 52.372728, 2009/01/18-15:08:04 Format : application/pdf Title : User Manual Creator : Philips Description : User Manual Subject : TCPDF Create Date : 2017:11:07 08:14:20+08:00 Creator Tool : TCPDF Modify Date : 2017:11:07 08:14:20+08:00 Metadata Date : 2017:11:07 08:14:20+08:00 Keywords : TCPDF Producer : TCPDF 6.0.037 (http://www.tcpdf.org) Document ID : uuid:0b5a56fd-72ff-f8e2-363c-4bb620cac890 Instance ID : uuid:0b5a56fd-72ff-f8e2-363c-4bb620cac890 Schemas Namespace URI : http://ns.adobe.com/pdf/1.3/ Schemas Prefix : pdf Schemas Schema : Adobe PDF Schema Schemas Property Category : internal Schemas Property Description : UUID based identifier for specific incarnation of a document Schemas Property Name : InstanceID Schemas Property Value Type : URI Author : Philips Trapped : FalseEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools